Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Thank you for buying Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Disregarding them
may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal
injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
Apple® iOS
RModel
ROrder
RCountry
variant
RAvailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the layout of components and controls
differs accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Android™
Please note that the Mercedes-Benz Guides
App may not yet be available in your country.
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all
documents on to the new owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
You can also use the CLA Guide smartphone
App:
1175843200Z102 É1175843200Z102^ËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 27
Introduction ......................................... 21
Safety ................................................... 39
Opening and closing ........................... 77
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 97
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 109
Climate control ................................. 125
Driving and parking .......................... 145
On-board computer and displays .... 213
Stowing and features ....................... 275
Maintenance and care ...................... 289
Breakdown assistance ..................... 305
Wheels and tyres .............................. 325
Technical data ................................... 351
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
4ETS
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
4ETS (Electronic Traction System) .... 68
4MATIC (permanent all-wheel
drive)
Display message ............................ 260
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) .................................................. 188
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 235
Function/notes ................................ 64
Important safety notes .................... 64
Warning lamp ................................. 265
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 136
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 130
Active light function ......................... 114
Active Parking Assist
Cancelling ...................................... 196
Detecting parking spaces .............. 193
Display message ............................ 253
Exiting a parking space .................. 195
Function/notes ............................. 192
Important safety notes .................. 192
Parking .......................................... 194
Towing a trailer .............................. 197
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 72
Adaptive Brake Assist
Display message ............................ 243
Function/notes ................................ 66
Adaptive brake lights .......................... 68
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Display message ............................ 248
Function/notes ............................. 115
Switching on/off ........................... 116
Additional speedometer ................... 226
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 360
Adjusting the headlamp range ......... 112
Air filter (white display message) .... 251
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Important safety notes .................. 143
Rear ............................................... 144
Setting ........................................... 143
Setting the centre air vents ........... 143
Setting the side air vents ............... 144
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Airbags
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 43
Important safety guidelines ............. 42
Kneebag ........................................... 44
Sidebag ............................................ 44
Triggering ......................................... 41
Windowbag ...................................... 45
Alarm
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 73
Switching off (ATA) .......................... 73
Switching the function on/off
(ATA) ................................................ 73
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 227
AMG
Performance Seat .......................... 103
AMG menu (on-board computer) ..... 231
Anti-glare film .................................... 287
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 172
Ashtray ............................................... 284
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 223
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 223
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 296
Hiding a service message .............. 296
Notes ............................................. 295
Index
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 296
Service message ............................ 295
Special service requirements ......... 296
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 73
Function ........................................... 73
Interior motion sensor ..................... 74
Switching off the alarm .................... 73
Tow-away protection ........................ 73
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 225
Display message ............................ 251
Function/notes ............................. 201
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 220
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 248
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 151
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 150
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 111
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position ............. 158
Automatic drive program ............... 160
Changing gear ............................... 158
DIRECT SELECT lever ..................... 155
Drive program display .................... 156
Driving tips .................................... 158
Emergency running mode .............. 163
Engaging drive position .................. 157
Engaging neutral ............................ 157
Engaging park position (AMG vehicles) ............................................... 157
Engaging reverse gear ................... 157
Engaging the park position ............ 156
Holding the vehicle stationary on
uphill gradients .............................. 158
Kickdown ....................................... 158
Manual drive program .................... 160
Overview ........................................ 155
Problem (fault) ............................... 163
Program selector button ................ 159
Pulling away ................................... 148
Selector lever ................................ 157
Starting the engine ........................ 148
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ... 160
Trailer towing ................................. 159
Transmission position display ........................................ 156, 157
Transmission positions .................. 157
Automatic transmission emergency running mode ......................... 163
Auxiliary heating
Activating/deactivating ................. 138
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) .............................. 139
Display message ............................ 262
Important safety notes .................. 138
Problem (display message) ............ 142
Remote control .............................. 139
Setting ........................................... 229
Setting the departure time ............. 140
Auxiliary ventilation
Activating/deactivating ................. 138
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) .............................. 139
Problem (display message) ............ 142
Remote control .............................. 139
Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ...................................................... 364
B
Ball coupling
Folding in ....................................... 211
Folding out ..................................... 209
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 64
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 80
Important safety notes .................... 80
Replacing ......................................... 81
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 314
Display message ............................ 250
Important safety notes .................. 312
Jump starting ................................. 316
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt force limiter
Activation ......................................... 50
Function ........................................... 50
5
6
Index
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 41
Function ........................................... 50
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating ................. 225
Display message ............................ 253
Notes/function .............................. 203
Trailer towing ................................. 205
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 290
Closing ........................................... 292
Display message ............................ 261
Important safety notes .................. 290
Opening ......................................... 291
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 88
Important safety notes .................... 86
Opening (automatically from outside) ................................................. 87
Opening automatically from
inside ............................................... 87
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ............................................ 87
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 260
Opening dimensions ...................... 362
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 362
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 241
Notes ............................................. 360
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 68
Changing bulbs .............................. 120
Display message ............................ 246
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 64
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 66
BAS .................................................. 64
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 360
Display message ............................ 235
Driving tips .................................... 171
HOLD function ............................... 186
Important safety notes .................. 171
Parking brake ................................ 168
Warning lamp ................................. 265
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
see Towing away/tow-starting
Bulbs
see Replacing bulbs
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Capacities (technical data) ............... 354
Car
see Vehicle
Car wash (care) ................................. 297
Care
Automatic car wash ....................... 297
Carpets .......................................... 303
Display ........................................... 302
Exhaust pipe .................................. 301
Exterior lighting ............................. 300
Gear or selector lever .................... 302
High-pressure cleaner .................... 298
Interior ........................................... 302
Matt paintwork .............................. 299
Notes ............................................. 297
Paint .............................................. 298
Plastic trim .................................... 302
Reversing camera .......................... 300
Roof lining ...................................... 303
Seat belt ........................................ 303
Seat cover ..................................... 302
Sensors ......................................... 300
Steering wheel ............................... 302
Trim pieces .................................... 302
Washing by hand ........................... 298
Wheels ........................................... 298
Windows ........................................ 299
Wiper blades .................................. 300
Wooden trim .................................. 302
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 229
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 79
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 35
Upper section .................................. 34
Changing bulbs
Brake lamps ................................... 120
Index
Cornering light function ................. 120
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 119
Main-beam headlamps ................... 119
Rear foglamp ................................. 120
Reversing lamps ............................ 120
Turn signals (front) ......................... 120
Turn signals (rear) .......................... 120
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 53
ISOFIX .............................................. 54
On the front-passenger seat ............ 52
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 62
Recommendations ........................... 59
Suitable positions ............................ 57
Top Tether ....................................... 55
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 62
Rear doors ....................................... 63
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 51
Restraint systems ............................ 51
Cigarette lighter ................................ 284
Cleaning
Trailer tow hitch ............................. 301
Climate control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 138
Controlling automatically ............... 132
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 136
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 130
Demisting the windows .................. 134
Demisting the windscreen ............. 134
Important safety notes .................. 126
Indicator lamp ................................ 132
Notes on using THERMATIC automatic climate control ..................... 127
Notes on using THERMOTRONIC
automatic climate control .............. 129
Overview of systems ...................... 126
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 136
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 132
Setting the air distribution ............. 133
Setting the air vents ...................... 143
Setting the airflow ......................... 133
Setting the temperature ................ 132
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 136
Switching on/off ........................... 130
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 137
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 135
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 133
THERMATIC automatic climate
control ........................................... 127
THERMOTRONIC (2-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 129
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 28
see Instrument cluster
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating the distance warning function .................. 224
Display message ............................ 235
Operation/notes .............................. 65
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS
Activating/deactivating ................. 224
Display message ............................ 242
Operation/notes .............................. 67
COMAND Online
see separate operating instructions
Combination switch .......................... 113
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 217
Convenience closing feature .............. 90
Convenience opening feature ............ 90
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 136
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 294
Display message ............................ 249
Important safety notes .................. 360
Temperature (on-board computer) ............................................. 231
Temperature gauge ........................ 214
Warning lamp ................................. 271
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright ............................................. 26
Cornering lamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 120
7
8
Index
Cornering light function
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
Crash-responsive emergency lighting .......................................................
Cruise control
Activation conditions .....................
Cruise control lever .......................
Deactivating ...................................
Display message ............................
Driving system ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear compartment .........................
245
114
117
174
174
175
255
173
173
174
174
175
174
283
282
283
D
Dashboard
see Instrument cluster
Data
see Technical data
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 248
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 226
Switching on/off (switch) .............. 111
Declarations of conformity ................. 23
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 228
Interior lighting .............................. 228
Diagnostics connection ...................... 23
Diesel .................................................. 357
Digital speedometer ......................... 218
Dipped-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 119
Display message ............................ 245
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 110
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 227
Switching on/off ........................... 111
DIRECT SELECT lever
see Automatic transmission
Display (cleaning instructions) ........ 302
Display message
Driving systems ............................. 251
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 295
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 234
Engine ............................................ 249
General information ....................... 234
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 234
Key ................................................ 263
Lights ............................................. 245
Safety systems .............................. 235
Tyres .............................................. 256
Vehicle ........................................... 258
Distance recorder
see Trip meter
Distance warning function
Activating/deactivating ................. 224
Function/notes ................................ 65
Warning lamp ................................. 273
DISTRONIC PLUS
Activation conditions ..................... 180
Cruise control lever ....................... 179
Deactivating ................................... 183
Display message ............................ 254
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 184
Driving tips .................................... 184
Function/notes ............................. 178
Important safety notes .................. 178
Selecting ........................................ 179
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 182
Warning lamp ................................. 273
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 229
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 85
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 79
Control panel ................................... 37
Display message ............................ 261
Emergency locking ........................... 86
Emergency unlocking ....................... 85
Important safety notes .................... 83
Opening (from the inside) ................ 84
Index
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 160
Display ........................................... 157
Display (DIRECT SELECT lever) ...... 156
Manual ........................................... 160
Driver's door
see Door
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 297
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 110
Driving on flooded roads .................. 172
Driving safety system
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS ................................................ 67
EBD (electronic brake force distribution) ............................................. 72
Driving safety systems
4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ................................................. 68
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 64
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 72
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 66
Adaptive brake lights ....................... 68
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 64
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST .... 65
Distance warning function ............... 65
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 68
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ..... 68
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ........................................... 68
Important safety guidelines ............. 64
Overview .......................................... 63
STEER CONTROL ............................. 72
Driving systems
Active Parking Assist ..................... 192
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 201
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 203
Cruise control ................................ 173
Display message ............................ 251
Distronic Plus ................................ 178
HOLD function ............................... 186
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 205
Lane package ................................ 203
PARKTRONIC ................................. 188
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .......... 187
Reversing camera .......................... 197
Speed Limit Assist ......................... 202
SPEEDTRONIC ...............................
Driving tips
Aquaplaning ...................................
Automatic transmission .................
Brakes ...........................................
DISTRONIC PLUS ...........................
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
Towing a trailer ..............................
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD audio (on-board computer) ......
175
172
158
171
184
171
110
172
172
172
170
172
172
172
146
329
110
207
171
221
E
EASY-VARIO-PLUS system
Luggage compartment enlargement .............................................. 279
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 237
Function/notes ................................ 72
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 170
On-board computer ....................... 218
ECO start/stop function
Automatic engine start .................. 151
Automatic engine switch-off .......... 150
Deactivating/activating ................. 151
General information ....................... 150
Important safety notes .................. 150
Introduction ................................... 150
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electromagnetic compatibility
Declaration of conformity ................ 23
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
9
10
Index
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 85
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 79
Inserting .......................................... 79
Locking vehicle ................................ 86
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 85
Emergency spare wheel
General notes ................................ 349
Important safety notes .................. 349
Removing ....................................... 350
Technical data ............................... 350
Emergency unlocking
Boot ................................................. 88
Vehicle ............................................. 85
Engine
Display message ............................ 249
ECO start/stop function ................ 150
Engine number ............................... 354
Jump-starting ................................. 316
Running irregularly ......................... 153
Starting problems .......................... 153
Starting the engine with the key .... 148
Stopping ........................................ 167
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 322
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 271
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 352
Problem (fault) ............................... 153
Engine jump starting
see Jump starting (engine)
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 360
Checking the oil level ..................... 292
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 292
Display message ............................ 250
Filling capacity ............................... 359
Notes about oil grades ................... 359
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 292
Temperature (on-board computer) ............................................. 231
Topping up ..................................... 293
Viscosity ........................................ 360
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 21
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
4ETS ................................................ 68
AMG menu (on-board computer) ... 231
Characteristics ................................. 69
Deactivating/activating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 70
Deactivating/activating (except
AMG vehicles) ................................ 224
Deactivating/activating (notes;
except AMG vehicles) ...................... 69
Display message ............................ 235
ETS .................................................. 68
ETS/4ETS ........................................ 68
Function/notes ................................ 68
General notes .................................. 68
Important safety guidelines ............. 68
Trailer stabilisation .......................... 71
Warning lamp ................................. 267
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ....... 68
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 68
Exhaust pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 301
Exterior lighting
Settings options ............................. 110
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 105
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 106
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 230
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 106
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 105
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 106
Parking position ............................. 106
Resetting ....................................... 106
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 107
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ............................... 307
First-aid kit ......................................... 306
Index
Fitting a wheel
Fitting a wheel ............................... 339
Lowering the vehicle ...................... 339
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 336
Raising the vehicle ......................... 337
Removing a wheel .......................... 339
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 336
Flat tyre
MOExtended tyres ......................... 308
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 308
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 309
see Emergency spare wheel
Floormat ............................................. 287
Foglamps
Extended range .............................. 115
Switching on/off ........................... 111
Frequencies
Mobile phone ................................. 352
Two-way radio ................................ 352
Front foglamps
Display message ............................ 247
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 357
Consumption information .............. 358
Consumption statistics .................. 217
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 218
Displaying the range ...................... 218
E10 ................................................ 356
Fuel gauge ....................................... 30
Grade (petrol) ................................ 356
Important safety notes .................. 355
Low outside temperatures ............. 358
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 357
Problem (malfunction) ................... 166
Quality (diesel) ............................... 357
Refuelling ....................................... 163
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 355
Fuel filler flap
Opening ......................................... 164
Fuel filter (white display message) .. 251
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 218
Gauge .............................................. 30
Fuel reserve
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................
Problem (malfunction) ...................
Fuses
Allocation chart .............................
Before changing .............................
Fuse box in the engine compartment ..............................................
Fuse box in the front-passenger
footwell ..........................................
Important safety notes ..................
355
166
323
323
323
323
322
G
Gear indicator (on-board computer) .................................................. 231
Gear or selector lever (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 302
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 231
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts ........... 21
Glove compartment .......................... 277
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
Hazard warning lamps ......................
Display message ............................
Head restraints
Adjusting .......................................
Adjusting (electrically) ...................
Adjusting (manually) ......................
Adjusting (rear) ..............................
Fitting/removing (rear) ..................
Headlamp
Cleaning system (function) ............
Cleaning system (notes) ................
Headlamps
Misting up ......................................
Topping up the cleaning system ....
see Automatic headlamp mode
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners ....................
Hill start assist ..................................
HOLD function
Activating .......................................
113
262
101
101
101
102
102
114
361
116
295
298
149
186
11
12
Index
Deactivating ................................... 186
Display message ............................ 251
Function/notes ............................. 186
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 72
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 271
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 273
Engine diagnostics ......................... 271
SPORT handling mode ................... 268
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 246
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Inspection
see ASSYST PLUS
Instrument cluster
Overview .......................................... 30
Settings ......................................... 226
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 32
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 214
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 227
Display message ............................ 248
Overview ........................................ 114
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left .. 227
Interior lighting ................................. 116
Automatic control system .............. 117
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 228
Emergency lighting ........................ 117
Manual control ............................... 117
Overview ........................................ 116
Reading lamp ................................. 116
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 227
Interior motion sensor
Deactivating ..................................... 74
Function ........................................... 74
Priming ............................................ 74
Switching off .................................... 74
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 54
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 307
Using ............................................. 337
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 316
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 81
Checking the battery ....................... 80
Convenience closing feature ............ 90
Convenience opening feature .......... 90
Display message ............................ 263
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 79
Emergency key element ................... 79
Important safety notes .................... 78
Loss ................................................. 82
Modifying the programming ............. 79
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 147
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 82
Starting the engine ........................ 148
Key positions (ignition lock) ............ 147
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 158
Manual drive program .................... 162
Kneebag ............................................... 44
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating .................
Display message ............................
Function/information ....................
Lane package .....................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Lashing eyelets .................................
Licence plate lamp (display message) ...................................................
Light sensor (display message) .......
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
225
252
205
203
232
281
247
248
227
Index
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off ....... 228
Active light function ....................... 114
Automatic headlamp mode ............ 111
Cornering light function ................. 114
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 111
Display message ............................ 245
Driving abroad ............................... 110
Foglamps ....................................... 111
Foglamps (extended range) ........... 115
Hazard warning lamps ................... 113
Headlamp flasher ........................... 113
Headlamp range ............................ 112
Light switch ................................... 110
Main-beam headlamps ................... 113
Motorway mode ............................. 114
Parking lamps ................................ 112
Rear foglamp ................................. 112
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 227
Side lamps ..................................... 112
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 226
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (switch) ..................... 111
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................ 228
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) .......... 228
Turn signals ................................... 113
see Interior lighting
see Replacing bulbs
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 174
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 179
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 176
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
Loading guidelines ............................ 276
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 85
Emergency locking ........................... 86
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 84
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ...............................
Luggage compartment enlargement ...................................................
Luggage net .......................................
Lumbar support
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................
229
279
279
102
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
Main-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs ..............................
Display message ............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Manual transmission
Engaging reverse gear ...................
Gear lever ......................................
Pulling away ...................................
Shift recommendation ...................
Shifting to neutral ..........................
Starting the engine ........................
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) ..
Media Interface
see Separate operating instructions
Memory card (audio) .........................
Memory function ...............................
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) ..................................................
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mobile phone
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Menu (on-board computer) ............
Notes/placing in the bracket .........
Transmission output (maximum) ....
328
119
247
113
155
154
148
155
155
148
299
221
107
234
352
352
221
286
352
13
14
Index
Mobile telephone
Pre-installed bracket ...................... 287
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 79
MOExtended tyres ............................. 308
Motorway mode ................................ 114
MP3
Operating ....................................... 221
see Separate operating instructions
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 216
Permanent display ......................... 226
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 215
Overview .......................................... 33
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 219
see separate operating instructions
Notes on running in a new vehicle .. 146
O
Occupant safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 51
Important safety notes .................... 40
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant protection) ............................... 46
Odometer ........................................... 217
see Total distance recorder
see Trip meter
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 231
Assistance menu ........................... 223
Audio menu ................................... 220
Convenience submenu .................. 230
Display messages .......................... 234
Displaying a service message ........ 296
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 184
Factory setting submenu ............... 231
Heating submenu ........................... 229
Important safety notes .................. 214
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 226
Light submenu ............................... 226
Menu overview .............................. 217
Message memory .......................... 234
Navigation menu ............................ 219
Operating video DVD ..................... 221
Operation ....................................... 215
RACETIMER ................................... 232
Service menu ................................. 225
Settings menu ............................... 225
Standard display ............................ 217
Telephone menu ............................ 221
Trip menu ...................................... 217
Vehicle submenu ........................... 228
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 120
Operating instructions
Vehicle equipment ........................... 22
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 23
Important safety note ...................... 22
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ........... 215
Overhead control panel ...................... 36
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 63
P
Paint code .......................................... 354
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 298
Panic alarm .......................................... 40
Panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 91
Opening/closing .............................. 92
Opening/closing the roller sunblind ................................................. 94
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 95
Rain closing feature ......................... 93
Resetting ......................................... 94
Parking ............................................... 167
Important safety notes .................. 167
Parking brake ................................ 168
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 106
Reversing camera .......................... 197
see Active Parking Assist
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 192
Index
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 238
Electric parking brake .................... 168
Warning lamp ................................. 270
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 247
Switching on/off ........................... 112
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 191
Driving system ............................... 188
Function/notes ............................. 188
Important safety notes .................. 188
Problem (fault) ............................... 192
Sensor range ................................. 189
Trailer towing ................................. 191
Warning display ............................. 190
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 62
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp ...................................................... 53
Petrol .................................................. 356
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 302
Power socket
Boot ............................................... 286
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Operation ......................................... 46
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 243
Program selector button .................. 159
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 21
Pulling away
Automatic transmission ................. 148
Manual transmission ...................... 148
Trailer ............................................ 149
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 24
R
RACE START (AMG vehicles) ............. 187
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 232
Radar sensor system
Activating/deactivating ................. 229
Display message ............................ 252
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 220
see separate operating instructions
Radio-based vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ................ 23
Rain closing feature (panorama
sliding sunroof) ................................... 93
Reading lamp ..................................... 116
Rear bench seat
Folding the backrest forwards/
back ............................................... 280
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 144
Rear foglamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 120
Display message ............................ 247
Switching on/off ........................... 112
Rear lamps
see Lights
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 136
Switching on/off ........................... 135
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 49
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 106
Dipping (manual) ........................... 105
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 30
Important safety notes .................. 163
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 357
Refuelling process ......................... 164
see Fuel
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 139
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 140
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes .................. 117
Overview of bulb types .................. 118
15
16
Index
Removing/replacing the cover
(front wheel arch) .......................... 119
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) .................... 140
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 250
Warning lamp ................................. 271
Residual heat (climate control) ........ 137
Restraint system
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Rev counter ........................................ 215
Reverse gear
Engaging (manual transmission) .... 155
Reverse gear (selector lever) ........... 157
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 300
Function/notes ............................. 197
Switching on/off ........................... 198
Reversing feature
Panorama sliding sunroof ................ 92
Roller sunblinds ............................... 93
Side windows ................................... 89
Reversing lamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 120
Reversing lamps
Display message ............................ 247
Roller sunblind
Opening/closing .............................. 94
Panorama sliding sunroof ................ 93
Roof carrier ........................................ 281
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ...................................... 303
Roof load (maximum) ........................ 362
Route (navigation)
see Route guidance (navigation)
Route guidance (navigation) ............ 219
S
Safety
Child restraint systems .................... 51
Children in the vehicle ..................... 51
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
Seat
Adjusting (Performance Seat) ........ 103
Folding the backrest (rear compartment) forwards/back .............. 280
Seat belt
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 230
Seat belts
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 48
Adjusting the height ......................... 48
Belt force limiter .............................. 50
Belt tensioner .................................. 50
Cleaning ......................................... 303
Display message ............................ 243
Fastening ......................................... 48
Important safety guidelines ............. 46
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 49
Releasing ......................................... 49
Warning lamp ................................. 263
Warning lamp (function) ................... 49
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 100
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 100
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 102
Adjusting the head restraint .......... 101
Cleaning the cover ......................... 302
Correct driver's seat position ........... 98
Important safety notes .................... 99
Seat heating problem .................... 104
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 107
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 103
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 300
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 225
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 360
Coolant (engine) ............................ 360
Engine oil ....................................... 359
Fuel ................................................ 355
Important safety notes .................. 354
Washer fluid ................................... 361
Index
Setting the air distribution ............... 133
Setting the airflow ............................ 133
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 231
On-board computer ....................... 225
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 231
Shifting to neutral (manual transmission) ............................................. 155
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 112
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 90
Convenience opening ...................... 90
Important safety notes .................... 88
Opening/closing .............................. 89
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 91
Resetting ......................................... 90
Sidebag ................................................ 44
Sliding sunroof
see Panorama sliding sunroof
Snow chains ...................................... 329
Socket
Points to observe before use ......... 285
Sockets
Centre console .............................. 285
Rear compartment ......................... 285
Specialist workshop ............................ 24
Spectacles compartment ................. 277
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 223
Display message ............................ 251
Display message in the multifunction display .................................... 203
Function/notes ............................. 202
Important safety notes .................. 202
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating the additional speedometer ........................ 226
Digital ............................................ 218
In the Instrument cluster ................. 30
Segments ...................................... 215
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 226
see Instrument cluster
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 177
Display message ............................ 255
Function/notes ............................. 175
Important safety notes .................. 176
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 176
Permanent ..................................... 177
Selecting ........................................ 176
Storing the current speed .............. 177
Variable ......................................... 176
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 70
Warning lamp ................................. 268
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Display message ............................ 244
Introduction ..................................... 41
Warning lamp ................................. 270
Warning lamp (function) ................... 41
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting (engine) ................................ 147
STEER CONTROL .................................. 72
Steering (display message) .............. 261
Steering wheel
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 104
Button overview ............................... 33
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 215
Cleaning ......................................... 302
Gearshift paddles ........................... 160
Important safety notes .................. 104
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 160
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 232
Stowage areas ................................... 276
Stowage compartments
Armrest (front) ............................... 278
Armrest (under) ............................. 278
Centre console .............................. 277
Centre console (rear) ..................... 279
Cup holder ..................................... 282
Glove compartment ....................... 277
Important safety information ......... 276
Luggage net ................................... 279
Spectacles compartment ............... 277
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 278
17
18
Index
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor ....................................................
Summer tyres ....................................
Sun visor ............................................
Supplemental restraint system
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Surround lighting (on-board computer) ..................................................
281
328
283
228
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................ 246
see Lights
Tank
see Fuel tank
Technical data
Emergency spare wheel ................. 350
Information .................................... 352
Trailer loads ................................... 364
Tyres/wheels ................................. 340
Vehicle data ................................... 362
Telephone
Accepting a call ............................. 222
Display message ............................ 262
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 221
Number from the phone book ........ 222
Redialling ....................................... 222
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 222
Telephone compartment ................ 278
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 214
Coolant (on-board computer) ......... 231
Engine oil (on-board computer) ...... 231
Outside temperature ...................... 215
Setting (climate control) ................ 132
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 173
Theft-deterrent system
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 73
Immobiliser ...................................... 72
Through-loading ................................ 279
Through-loading feature ................... 279
Time
see Separate Owner's manual
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 232
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 309
Top Tether ............................................ 55
Tow-away protection
Activating ......................................... 73
Deactivating ..................................... 73
Function ........................................... 73
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 322
Fitting the towing eye .................... 320
Important safety notes .................. 318
Removing the towing eye ............... 320
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 318
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles ............ 321
Towing a trailer
Active Parking Assist ..................... 197
Axle load, permissible .................... 364
Bulb failure indicator for LED
lamps ............................................. 212
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 71
Pulling away with a trailer .............. 149
Trailer tow hitch display message .. 261
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 320
Removing the towing eye ............... 320
With both axles on the ground ....... 321
With front axle raised ..................... 320
Trailer coupling
see Towing a trailer
Trailer towing
7-pin connector ............................. 212
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 205
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch ......... 301
Coupling up a trailer ...................... 210
Decoupling a trailer ....................... 210
Driving tips .................................... 207
Folding in the ball coupling ............ 211
Folding out the ball coupling .......... 209
Important safety notes .................. 207
Lights display message .................. 245
Mounting dimensions .................... 363
Parktronic ...................................... 191
Power supply ................................. 211
Trailer loads ................................... 364
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
see Manual transmission
Index
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ......................
Transporting the vehicle ..................
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip meter
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
Turn signals
Changing bulbs (front) ...................
Changing bulbs (rear) ....................
Switching on/off ...........................
Two-way radio
Frequencies ...................................
Installation .....................................
Transmission output (maximum) ....
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
General notes ................................
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
M+S tyres ......................................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Replacing ....................................... 335
Service life ..................................... 327
Storing ........................................... 336
Summer tyres ........................ 172, 328
Tyre size (data) .............................. 340
Tyre tread ...................................... 327
Wheel and tyre combinations ........ 342
see Flat tyre
156
321
302
217
217
218
120
120
113
352
352
352
332
256
332
311
311
330
331
331
332
333
332
332
332
334
274
334
335
327
336
256
326
328
328
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 85
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 84
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 284
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
see SPEEDTRONIC
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 24
Data acquisition ............................... 25
Electronics ..................................... 352
Equipment ....................................... 22
Implied warranty .............................. 25
Individual settings .......................... 225
Leaving parked up ......................... 169
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 86
Locking (key) ................................... 79
Lowering ........................................ 339
Pulling away ................................... 148
Raising ........................................... 337
Registration ..................................... 24
Securing from rolling away ............ 336
Tow-starting ................................... 318
Towing away .................................. 318
Transporting .................................. 321
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 85
Unlocking (key) ................................ 79
Vehicle data ................................... 362
Vehicle data ....................................... 362
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 362
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 86
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 354
19
20
Index
Vehicle maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Vehicle tool kit ..................................
Vehicle weights .................................
Video (DVD) ........................................
Video DVD (on-board computer) ......
VIN ......................................................
307
362
221
221
354
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 265
Brakes ........................................... 265
Distance warning signal ................. 273
ESP® ............................................. 267
ESP® OFF ...................................... 268
Fuel tank ........................................ 271
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 174
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 179
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 176
Overview .......................................... 32
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF ................ 53
Reserve fuel ................................... 271
Seat belt ........................................ 263
SRS ................................................ 270
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 274
Warning triangle ................................ 306
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 262
Wheel and tyre combinations
see Tyres
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 339
Wheel chock ...................................... 336
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 335
Changing/replacing ....................... 335
Checking ........................................ 327
Cleaning ......................................... 298
Cleaning (warning) ......................... 336
Emergency spare wheel ................. 349
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 339
Fitting a wheel ............................... 336
Important safety notes .................. 326
Removing a wheel .......................... 339
Storing ........................................... 336
Tightening torque ........................... 339
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 340
Windowbag
Display message ............................ 245
Operation ......................................... 45
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 299
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 134
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Notes ............................................. 361
Topping up ..................................... 295
Windscreen wipers
Display message ............................ 262
Problem (malfunction) ................... 124
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 122
Switching on/off ........................... 121
Winter driving
General notes ................................ 328
Winter operation
Slippery road surfaces ................... 172
Snow chains .................................. 329
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) ............................................. 228
M+S tyres ...................................... 328
Wiper blades
Cleaning ......................................... 300
Important safety notes .................. 122
Replacing (windscreen) .................. 122
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 302
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 133
Introduction
Protection of the environment
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
Our objectives are to use the natural resources which form the basis of our existence on
this planet sparingly and in a manner which
takes the requirements of both nature and
humanity into consideration.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. Therefore,
please bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
short trips, as these increase fuel
consumption.
Robserve the correct tyre pressure.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight in the
vehicle.
Rremove the roof rack once you no longer
need it.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Rall maintenance work should be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Rmonitor the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rswitch
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
EU countries only:
Mercedes-Benz will take back your old vehicle
to dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible manner in accordance with the European Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles Directive.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants available. You can return
your vehicle to these plants free of charge.
This makes a valuable contribution to the
recycling process and the conservation of
resources.
For further information on recycling old vehicles, recovery and the terms of the policy,
visit the Mercedes-Benz homepage.
Ravoid
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine when the vehicle
is stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
Ravoid frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems, may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Rdoor
Z
21
22
Introduction
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
You could jeopardise the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tyres and wheels
as well as accessories relevant to safety
which have not been approved by Mercedes.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Use
only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of
equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels and
accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz
therefore accepts no responsibility for the
use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles,
even if they have been officially approved or
independently approved by a testing centre.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if
they comply with legal requirements. This
also applies to some other countries. All genuine Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
This is the case:
Rif
they cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) when ordering genuine MercedesBenz parts (Y page 354).
Owner's Manual
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation for your vehicle contains a list of all of the
systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or necessary repairs carried out, this could result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as necessary repairs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Introduction
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system. There is a risk
of fire.
When driving off road or on unpaved roads,
check the vehicle's underside regularly. In
particular, remove parts of plants or other
flammable materials which have become
trapped. In the case of damage, contact a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring could effect their
function and/or the operation of other networked components. This could in particular
also be the case for systems relevant to
safety. They might not function properly any
more and/or jeopardise the operational
safety of the vehicle. There is an increased
risk of an accident and injury.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
Always have work on electrical and electronic
components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the underbody panelling is damaged,
combustible materials such as leaves,
grass or twigs can gather between the
underbody and the underbody panelling. If
these materials come in contact with hot
parts of the exhaust system, they can catch
fire.
In such situations, have the vehicle
checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop. If, upon continuing your journey, you notice that driving
safety is impaired, pull over and stop the
vehicle immediately, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. In such cases,
visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
If you make any changes to the vehicle electronics, the general operating permit is rendered invalid.
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the information
systems and communication devices integrated into the vehicle which receive and/or
transmit radio waves:
The components of this vehicle that receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and all other relevant conditions of Directive 1999/5/EC.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Electromagnetic compatibility
Rthe vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
kerb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
kerb or a pothole in the road
Ra heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tyres could
be damaged without the damage being visible. Components damaged in this way can
unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an accident, no longer withstand the strain they
are designed for.
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version of
Regulation ECE-R 10.
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
23
24
Introduction
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it can affect the
operation of the vehicle systems. This may
affect the operating safety of the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment on the diagnostics connection is
used, the starter battery may discharge.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics
connection can lead to emissions monitoring
information being reset, for example. This
may lead to the vehicle failing to meet the
requirements of the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications
to correctly carry out any necessary work on
your vehicle. This particularly applies to work
relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
and maintenance work
Rservice
Rrepair
work
Rmodifications,
installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle is
improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about
vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet
been registered in your name in the following
cases:
Rif
your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined at
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership. You can do this at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, for example.
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or
others could fail to recognise certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
technical data in this manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rthe
Introduction
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Data stored in the vehicle
A wide range of electronic components in
your vehicle contain data memories.
These data memories temporarily or permanently store technical information about:
Rthe
vehicle's operating state
Revents
Rfaults
In general, this technical information documents the state of a component, a module, a
system or the surroundings.
These include, for example:
Roperating
conditions of system components, e.g. fluid levels
Rthe vehicle's status messages and those of
its individual components, e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration in
movement, lateral acceleration, accelerator pedal position
Rmalfunctions and defects in important system components, e.g. lights, brakes
Rvehicle reactions and operating conditions
in special driving situations, e.g. airbag
deployment, intervention of stability control systems
Rambient conditions, e.g. outside temperature
This data is of an exclusively technical nature
and can be used to:
Rassist
in recognising and rectifying faults
and defects
Ranalyse vehicle functions, e.g. after an accident
Roptimise vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical information can be read from the event data memory and fault data memory.
Services include, for example:
Rrepair
services
processes
Rwarranty events
Rquality assurance
It is read by employees of the service network
(including manufacturers) using special diagnostic testers. More detailed information is
obtained from it, if required.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the fault memory or is
continually overwritten.
When operating the vehicle, situations are
conceivable in which this technical data, in
connection with other information (if necessary, under consultation with an authorised
expert), could be traced to a person.
Examples include:
Rservice
Raccident
reports
to the vehicle
Rwitness statements
Further additional functions that have been
contractually agreed upon with the customer
allow certain vehicle data to be conveyed by
the vehicle as well. The additional functions
include, for example, vehicle location in case
of an emergency.
Rdamage
Z
25
26
Introduction
Copyright information
General notes
Information on licences for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
opensource
27
Cockpit ................................................. 28
Multifunction steering wheel ............. 33
Centre console .................................... 34
Overhead control panel ...................... 36
Door control panel .............................. 37
At a glance
Instrument cluster .............................. 30
28
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
160
;
Combination switch
113
=
Instrument cluster
30
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
155
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
C
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
D
Climate control systems
126
E
Ignition lock
147
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
104
G
Cruise control lever
174
H
Electric parking brake
168
I
Light switch
110
188
J
Diagnostics connection
36
K
Opens the bonnet
23
291
29
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
188
=
Combination switch
113
?
Instrument cluster
30
A
Horn
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
155
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
160
36
Function
Page
D
Light switch
110
E
Electric parking brake
168
F
Opens the bonnet
291
G
Diagnostics connection
H
Ignition lock
147
I
Adjusts the steering wheel
104
J
Cruise control lever
174
K
Climate control systems
126
23
30
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays and controls
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
215
;
Multifunction display
216
=
Rev counter
215
?
Coolant temperature
A
Fuel gauge
B
Instrument cluster lighting
Page
214
214
31
At a glance
Instrument cluster
i Instrument cluster: miles
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
215
;
Multifunction display
216
=
Rev counter
215
?
Coolant temperature
A
Fuel gauge
B
Instrument cluster lighting
Page
214
214
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
:
L Dipped-beam headlamps
111
;
T Side lamps
112
=
K Main-beam headlamps
113
?
÷ ESP®
267
A
! Electric parking brake
(red)
270
B
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
270
C
· Distance warning
273
D
#! Turn signals
113
E
6 SRS
270
F
ü Seat belt
263
Function
G
% Diesel engine: preglow
M SPORT handling
mode in AMG vehicles
Page
148
268
H
? Coolant
271
I
R Rear foglamp
112
J
N Foglamps
111
K
; Engine diagnostics
271
L
h Tyre pressure monitor
274
M
æ Reserve fuel
271
N
å ESP® OFF
267
O
! ABS
265
P
J Brakes
265
Multifunction steering wheel
33
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio/COMAND display;
see the separate operating
instructions
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC, see the separate
operating instructions
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
Page
216
Function
A
B
221
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Switches off LINGUATRONIC, see the separate
operating instructions
Page
215
215
215
234
215
34
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Centre console, upper section
Function
Page
:
Audio system/COMAND
Online; see the separate
operating instructions
;
c Seat heating
103
=
c PARKTRONIC
188
?
¤ ECO start/stop function
150
A
£ Hazard warning
lamps
113
Function
Page
B
4 5 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
53
C
Ú Selects the drive program
å AMG vehicles: ESP®
159
70
D
& Auxiliary heating
138
Centre console
35
At a glance
Centre console, lower section
i Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
Function
:
;
Function
Page
Page
=
Cup holders
282
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Stowage compartment
284
284
285
276
?
Stowage compartment with
Media Interface
276
A
Stowage compartment
276
Audio/COMAND controller; see the separate operating instructions
36
Overhead control panel
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
:
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
117
;
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
116
=
| Switches the front
interior lighting/automatic
interior lighting control off
117
?
ë Deactivates towaway protection
A
Rear-view mirror
73
105
Function
Page
B
ê Deactivates the interior motion sensor
74
C
Spectacles compartment
277
D
3 Opens/closes the
panorama sliding sunroof
with roller sunblinds
92
E
c Switches the front
interior lighting on
117
F
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
116
Door control panel
37
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
84
B
;
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
W Opens/closes the
side windows
89
84
C
=
r45= Saves
the seat and exterior mirror
settings
107
n Activates/deactivates the override feature
for the side windows in the
rear compartment
63
?
Adjusts the seats electrically
o Opens the boot
87
100
A
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
105
D
38
39
Useful information .............................. 40
Panic alarm .......................................... 40
Occupant safety .................................. 40
Driving safety systems ....................... 63
Anti-theft systems .............................. 72
Safety
Children in the vehicle ........................ 51
Occupant safety
40
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Safety
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Panic alarm
more. The restraint systems could then no
longer protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do and could fail in the event of an
accident or activate unexpectedly, for example. There is an increased risk of injury.
Never modify parts of the restraint systems.
Do not attempt to modify the wiring as well as
electronic components or their software.
The airbag system can be adapted for a person with disabilities. For further information,
consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The seat belts, together with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), are complementary, co-ordinated restraint systems
(Y page 41). They reduce the risk of injury in
specific, pre-defined types of accident situations and thereby increase occupant safety.
However, seat belts and airbags generally do
not protect against objects penetrating the
vehicle from the outside.
To ensure that the restraint systems can
deliver their full potential protection, make
sure that:
Rthe
To activate: press ! button : for
approximately one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
X
i The panic alarm function is only available
in certain countries.
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Modifications to the restraint systems could
result in them not functioning properly any
seat and head restraint are adjusted
properly (Y page 98)
Rthe seat belt has been fastened properly
(Y page 46)
Rthe airbags can inflate properly if they are
deployed (Y page 42)
Rthe steering wheel is adjusted properly
(Y page 104)
Rthe restraint systems have not been modified
An airbag increases the protection of vehicle
occupants wearing a seat belt. However, airbags are only an additional restraint system
that complements, but does not replace, the
seat belt. All vehicle occupants must wear
their seat belts correctly at all times, even if
the vehicle is equipped with airbags. The airbags are not deployed in all types of accidents. For example, if the protective capacity
of correctly fastened seat belts is not
increased by deploying the airbags, the airbags will not deploy.
Airbag deployment only provides increased
protection if the seat belt is worn correctly.
The seat belt helps, firstly, to keep the vehicle
occupant in the best position in relation to the
airbag. Secondly, in a head-on collision, for
example, the seat belt restricts movement of
the vehicle occupant towards the point of
impact.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Introduction
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) with:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp
Rairbags
Rairbag
control unit (with crash sensors)
tensioners for the front seat belts and
the outer seat belts in the rear
Rseat belt force limiters for the front seat
belts and the outer seat belts in the rear
SRS reduces the risk of vehicle occupants
coming into contact with parts of the vehicle's interior in the event of an accident. It can
also reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants are subjected during an accident.
Rbelt
SRS warning lamp
G WARNING
If SRS is malfunctioning, restraint system
components may be triggered unintentionally
or might not be triggered at all in the event of
an accident with a high rate of vehicle deceleration. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Have SRS checked and repaired immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop.
SRS functions are checked regularly when
you switch on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions
can be detected in good time.
The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
The SRS components are in operational readiness when the 6 SRS warning lamp goes
out while the engine is running.
A malfunction has occurred if:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp does not light
up when the ignition is switched on
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp does not go out after a few
seconds
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp lights up again
Triggering of belt tensioners and airbags
During the first stage of a collision, the airbag
control unit evaluates important physical
data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rmagnitude
Based on the evaluation of this data, the airbag control unit pre-emptively triggers the
belt tensioners in the first stage.
If there is an even higher rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration in a longitudinal direction, the front airbags are also deployed.
Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front airbags. The airbag control unit evaluates vehicle deceleration or acceleration in the event
of a collision. In the first deployment stage,
the front airbag is filled with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries. The
front airbag is fully deployed if a second
deployment threshold is reached within a few
milliseconds.
The belt tensioner and airbag triggering
thresholds are variable and are adapted to the
detected rate of deceleration or acceleration
of the vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in
nature. The triggering process must take
place in good time at the start of the collision.
Z
41
Safety
Occupant safety
42
Occupant safety
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Safety
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly,
e.g. the bonnet or the wing, without an airbag
being deployed. This is the case if only parts
which are relatively easily deformed are affected and the rate of deceleration is not high.
Conversely, airbags may be deployed even
though the vehicle suffers only minor deformation. This is the case if, for example, very
rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body
members are hit, and sufficient deceleration
occurs as a result.
i The front belt tensioners can only be triggered if the seat belt tongues on the front
seats are correctly engaged in the seat belt
buckles.
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The different airbag systems work
independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by predicting the severity of the accident, especially vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the type of accident:
Rhead-on
collision
impact
Roverturn
Rside
Airbags
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Airbags provide additional protection; they
are not, however, a substitute for seat belts.
Observe the following notes to reduce the risk
of serious or even fatal injury caused by airbag
deployment:
Rall
vehicle occupants – in particular, pregnant women – must wear their seat belt
correctly at all times and lean back against
the backrest, which should be positioned
as close to the vertical as possible. The
head restraint must support the back of the
head at about eye level.
Ralways secure children less than 1.50 m tall
or under 12 years of age in suitable child
restraint systems.
Rall vehicle occupants must select a seat
position that is as far away from the airbag
as possible. The driver's seat position must
allow the vehicle to be driven safely. The
driver's chest should be as far away from
the centre of the driver's airbag cover as
possible.
Rmove the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. This is especially important if
you have secured a child in a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
Rvehicle occupants – in particular, children –
must not lean their head into the area of the
window in which the sidebag/windowbag is
deployed.
Rrearward-facing child restraint systems
must not be fitted to the front-passenger
seat unless the front-passenger airbag has
been disabled. On the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger airbag is disabled
if a child restraint system with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition
is fitted to the front-passenger seat in a
vehicle equipped with automatic child seat
recognition. The 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
Occupant safety
G WARNING
If you modify the airbag covers or affix
objects, e.g. stickers to them, the airbags may
no longer function as intended. There is an
increased risk of injury.
Never modify the airbag covers and do not
affix any objects to them.
G WARNING
After the driver's airbag has been deployed,
the airbag parts are hot. There is a risk of
injury.
Do not touch the airbag parts. Have deployed
airbags replaced immediately at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Airbag deployment slows down and restricts
the movement of the vehicle occupants.
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard and does not indicate that there
is a fire in the vehicle. The powder may cause
short-term breathing difficulties to persons
suffering from asthma or other pulmonary
conditions. In order to prevent potential
breathing difficulties, you should leave the
vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. You can
also open the window to allow fresh air to
enter the vehicle interior. The 6 SRS warning lamp lights up.
The airbag installation locations are identified
by the AIRBAG symbol.
i After an airbag has been deployed, have
the vehicle towed to the nearest qualified
specialist workshop, even if your vehicle
can still be driven.
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied.
In the event of an accident, the restraint
systems on the front-passenger side may
be triggered and have to be replaced.
Z
Safety
OFF indicator lamp must be continuously
lit.
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle
does not have automatic child seat recognition, or your rearward-facing child
restraint system does not have a transponder for automatic child seat recognition, children must be secured in a child
restraint system on a suitable seat in the
rear. If you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
Rmake sure there are no heavy or sharpedged objects in the pockets of clothing.
Rdo not lean forwards, e.g. over the cover of
the driver's/front-passenger front airbag,
particularly when the vehicle is in motion.
Rdo not put your feet on the dashboard.
Ronly hold the steering wheel on the outside.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
You could be injured if the airbag is
deployed and you are holding the inside of
the steering wheel.
Rdo not lean on the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Rmake sure that there are no people, animals or objects between the vehicle occupants and the area where the airbags are
deployed.
Rdo not place any objects between the seat
backrest and the door.
Rdo not hang any hard objects, e.g. coat
hangers, on the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rdo not attach accessories, e.g. cup holders,
to the doors.
It is not possible to rule out a risk of injury
being caused by an airbag, due to the high
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
43
44
Occupant safety
If a child restraint system is fitted to the frontpassenger seat and the PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp on the centre console is
not lit:
child restraint system without a transponder for automatic child seat recognition
has been fitted or
Ra child restraint system with a transponder
has been fitted incorrectly
Safety
Ra
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front airbag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
The front airbags increase protection for the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
chest.
They are deployed:
Driver's kneebag
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of
vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
longitudinal direction.
Rif the system determines that airbag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt.
Rindependently of other airbags in the vehicle.
The time within which the front airbag is
deployed is dependent on whether or not a
seal belt is worn.
If the vehicle overturns, the front airbags are
generally not deployed.
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: frontpassenger front airbag ; is only enabled if
the system determines that the frontpassenger seat is occupied. The PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp on the centre
console is not lit (Y page 53).
Driver's kneebag : deploys underneath the
steering column. The driver's kneebag is triggered together with the front airbag. The driver's kneebag is designed to operate together
with the front airbags in frontal impacts if certain thresholds are exceeded. The driver's
kneebag operates best in conjunction with
correctly positioned and fastened seat belts.
Driver's kneebag : increases the driver's
protection against:
Rknee
injuries
injuries
Rlower leg injuries
Rthigh
Sidebags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers may obstruct or even
prevent deployment of the airbags integrated
into the seats. The airbags may then fail to
protect the vehicle occupants as intended.
Operation of the automatic child seat recog-
nition may also be impaired. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Use only seat covers which have been specifically approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door panelling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
function of the sensors being impaired. The
airbags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the airbags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. This poses an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door panelling carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
You should only use seat covers that have
been approved for your vehicle by MercedesBenz. The seat covers must have a special
tear seam for sidebags. Otherwise, the sidebags cannot deploy correctly and therefore
cannot provide the intended protection in the
event of an accident.
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ;
deploy next to the outer seat cushions.
When deployed, the sidebags offer additional
protection of the thorax for occupants on the
front seats as well as of the pelvis for the
vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle
on which the impact occurs. However, they
do not protect the:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
The sidebags are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of
lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration,
e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
Rindependently of the front airbags
If the vehicle overturns, the sidebags are generally not deployed. Sidebags are deployed if
the system detects high vehicle deceleration
or acceleration in a lateral direction and
determines that sidebag deployment can
offer additional protection to that provided by
the seat belts.
Windowbags
Windowbags : enhance the level of protection for the head (but not chest or arms) of the
vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle
on which the impact occurs.
Windowbags : are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deployed in the area
from the A-pillar to the C-pillar.
Z
45
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
46
Occupant safety
Windowbags are deployed:
Function
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate of
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration,
e.g. in a side impact
Ron the side on which an impact occurs
Ron the driver's and the front-passenger's
side if the vehicle overturns and the system
determines that deployment can offer additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rregardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Rindependently of the front airbags
PRE-SAFE® (anticipatory occupant
protection)
Introduction
PRE-SAFE® takes pre-emptive measures to
protect occupants in certain hazardous situations.
Important safety notes
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
Although your vehicle is equipped with a PRESAFE® system, the possibility of injury in the
event of an accident cannot be ruled out.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions and
maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in
front. Drive carefully.
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. when
BAS is activated.
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when phys-
ical limits are exceeded and the vehicle
understeers or oversteers severely.
Ron vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS: when
adaptive Brake Assist intervenes powerfully.
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
the vehicle skids, the panorama sliding
sunroof and the side windows are closed so
that only a small gap remains.
Rvehicles with the memory function: the
front-passenger seat is adjusted if it is in an
unfavourable position.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pre-tensioning. All settings made by
PRE-SAFE® can then be reversed.
If the seat belts are not released:
Rif
X
Move the backrest or seat back slightly, but
only when the vehicle is stationary.
Seat belt pre-tensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. More
information about seat-belt adjustment can
be found under "Seat-belt adjustment"
(Y page 48).
Seat belts
Important safety notes
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or
which has not been engaged in the seat belt
buckle correctly, cannot provide the intended
level of protection. Under certain circumstances, this could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the event of an accident.
Therefore, make sure that all occupants — in
particular, pregnant women — wear their seat
belts correctly at all times.
RThe
seat belt must fit snugly on your body
and must not be twisted. Therefore, avoid
wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter coat.
The shoulder section of the belt must be
routed across the centre of your shoulder —
on no account across your neck or under
your arm — and pulled tight against your
upper body. The lap belt must always pass
across your lap as low down as possible, i.e.
over your hip joints — not across your abdomen. If necessary, push the seat belt
slightly downwards and adjust it by pulling
it in the direction the seat belt retracts.
RDo not route the seat belt strap over sharp
or fragile objects. Please make sure that
such objects are not on or in your clothing,
e.g. spectacles, pens or keys etc. The seat
belt strap could become damaged and tear
during an accident and you or other vehicle
occupants could be injured.
ROnly one person should use each seat belt
at any one time. Children must never travel
sitting on the lap of another occupant. The
child will not be secured in the event of an
accident, heavy braking or sudden change
of direction. This may result in the child or
other occupants being seriously or fatally
injured.
RPersons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly. For this reason secure
persons less than 1.50 m tall in specially
designed, suitable restraint systems.
RChildren under 1.50 m tall and younger
than twelve years of age cannot wear the
seat belts correctly. For this reason secure
them in special suitable child restraint systems installed on a suitable seat. Additional
information can be found in the Operating
Instructions in the chapter "Safety", "Children in the Vehicle". Observe the installa-
tion instructions of the child restraint system manufacturer.
RDo not secure an object with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if the backrest is not in the
upright position. When braking or in the event
of an accident, you could slide underneath the
seat belt and sustain abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This poses an increased risk
of injury or even fatal injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the seat
is in the upright position.
G WARNING
Seat belts cannot perform their intended protective function if:
Rthey
are damaged, modified, bleached or
coloured, or are very dirty
Rthe seat belt buckle is damaged or very
dirty
Rmodifications have been made to the seat
belt tensioners or belt anchorages
In the event of an accident, seat belts can
sustain damage that is not visible to the naked
eye, e. g. due to glass splinters. Modified or
damaged seat belts could tear or fail in the
event of an accident, for example. Modified
belt tensioners could deploy unexpectedly or
fail. There is an increased risk of serious or
even fatal injuries.
Never make modifications to seat belts, belt
tensioners, belt anchorages or seat belt
retractors. Make sure that the seat belts are
undamaged, are not worn and are clean.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use seat belts which have been approved
specifically for your vehicle by MercedesBenz.
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restraining the movement of vehicle occuZ
47
Safety
Occupant safety
Occupant safety
48
pants in the event of an accident. This
reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming
into contact with parts of the vehicle interior.
Safety
Fastening seat belts
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment function adjusts the
driver's and front-passenger seat belt to the
upper body of the occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Ryou
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 98).
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from belt sash
guide :.
X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of
your shoulder and the lap section across
your pelvis.
X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =.
Seat belt adjustment: if necessary, the driver's and front-passenger seat belts automatically adjust to the upper body
(Y page 48).
X If necessary, adjust the seat belt to the
appropriate height (Y page 48).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
Information on releasing the seat belt with
release button ? (Y page 49).
engage the belt tongue in the belt
buckle and you then turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock.
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
and you then engage the belt tongue in the
buckle.
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the occupant and the seat belt. Do
not hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is
adjusting. You can switch the seat-belt
adjustment on and off in the on-board computer (Y page 230).
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. More
information about PRE-SAFE® can be found in
the "PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant protection)" section (Y page 46).
Belt height adjustment
You can adjust the belt height for the front
seats. Adjust the belt to a height that allows
the upper part of the seat belt to be routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
To raise: slide the belt guide upwards.
The belt guide will engage in various positions.
X To lower: hold belt guide release : and
slide the belt guide downwards.
X Let go of belt guide release : in the
desired position and make sure that the
belt guide engages.
X
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone ceases once the driver and
the front passenger have fastened their seat
belt.
Only for certain countries: the 7 seat belt
warning lamp lights up for six seconds after
every engine start. It lights up regardless of
whether the driver's and front-passenger seat
belts have already been fastened. If the driver's and front-passenger seat belts have
already been fastened, the 7 seat belt
warning lamp then goes out.
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see "Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belt" (Y page 263).
Rear seat belt status indicator
Example: rear seat belt status indicator
X
X
Press release button ? on belt buckle =.
Guide belt tongue ; back to belt guide :.
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all occupants to
fasten their seat belts. It may light up continuously or flash. In addition, a warning tone
may sound.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator shows the rear seat on which the belt is
fastened. In the example, the occupant on the
right rear seat, when viewed in the direction
of travel, is secured. The ü symbol in the
display indicates a fastened seat belt. If a seat
belt is not fastened or if a seat is not occupied,
the ý symbol is displayed.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator appears in the multifunction display for
around 30 seconds if:
Ryou
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h.
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion.
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
the vehicle drives off again.
Z
49
Safety
Occupant safety
50
Occupant safety
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 234).
Safety
i The status indicator for the rear-compart-
ment seat belts is only available for certain
countries.
Belt tensioners, belt force limiters
G WARNING
Pyrotechnic seat belt tensioners that have
been deployed are no longer operational and
are unable to perform their intended protective function. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Therefore, have pyrotechnic belt tensioners
which have been triggered immediately
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
! If the front-passenger seat is not occu-
pied, do not engage the seat belt tongue in
the buckle on the front-passenger seat.
Otherwise, the belt tensioner could be triggered in the event of an accident.
i Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: an electric
motor is used by PRE-SAFE® to trigger the
tightening of the seat belt in hazardous situations. This procedure is reversible.
The front seat belts and the outer seat belts in
the rear are equipped with belt tensioners
and belt force limiters.
The belt tensioners tighten the seat belts in an
accident, pulling them close against the body.
Belt tensioners do not correct incorrect seat
positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts.
Belt tensioners do not pull vehicle occupants
back towards the backrest.
The belt tensioners can only be activated
when:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
restraint systems are operational; see
"SRS warning lamp 6" (Y page 41)
Rthe belt tongue has engaged in the belt
buckle of the respective front seat
Rthe
The belt tensioners on the outside seats in the
rear compartment are triggered independently of the lock status of the seat belts.
The belt tensioners are triggered depending
on the accident type and severity:
Rin
the event of a head-on or rear-end collision if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact
Rin the event of a side impact if the vehicle
decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction on the side opposite to the
impact
Rin certain situations where the vehicle overturns and the system determines that it can
provide additional protection
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard and does not indicate that there
is a fire in the vehicle. The powder may cause
short-term breathing difficulties to persons
suffering from asthma or other pulmonary
conditions. In order to prevent potential
breathing difficulties, you should leave the
vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. You can
also open the window to allow fresh air to
enter the vehicle interior. The 6 SRS warning lamp lights up.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The belt force limiters on the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags, which
take on a part of the deceleration force. This
results in the load being distributed over a
greater area.
Children in the vehicle
Child restraint systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
RChildren
less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age must always be secured
in special child restraint systems on a suitable vehicle seat. This is necessary
because the seat belts are not designed for
children.
RDo not transport children who are secured
in rearward-facing child restraint systems
on the front-passenger seat. Exception: if
the vehicle is equipped with automatic child
seat recognition on the front-passenger
seat and the child is secured in a child
restraint system with transponders for
automatic child seat recognition
RIf you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible. When doing so,
ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the
belt outlet on the vehicle is routed towards
the front to the shoulder belt guide on the
child restraint system. Set the belt height
adjustment so that the belt strap is routed
towards the front along the bottom.
RChildren must never travel sitting on the lap
of another occupant. Due to the forces
which occur in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident, it would not be possible to
restrain the child. The child could be thrown
against parts of the vehicle interior and be
seriously or even fatally injured.
G WARNING
tive function. In the event of an accident,
sharp braking or a sudden change in direction,
the child may not be held securely. There is an
increased risk of serious or even fatal injuries.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the correct use for the child
restraint system. Make sure that the entire
surface of the child restraint system is resting
on the seat surface. Never place objects
under or behind the child restraint system,
e.g. cushions. Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for
them. Only replace damaged covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is fitted incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always fit child restraint systems properly,
even if they are not being used. Make sure
that you observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems that have been damaged or subjected to
a load in an accident cannot perform their
intended protective function. In the event of
an accident, sharp braking or a sudden
change in direction, the child may not be held
securely. There is an increased risk of serious
or even fatal injuries.
Immediately replace child restraint systems
that have been damaged or subjected to a
load in an accident. Have the child restraint
securing systems checked in a qualified specialist workshop before fitting a child restraint
system again.
If the child restraint system is incorrectly fitted on the seat position suitable for this purpose, it cannot perform its intended protecZ
51
Safety
Children in the vehicle
52
Children in the vehicle
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Safety
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake.
the automatic transmission out of
parking position P.
Rshift the manual transmission into neutral.
Rstart the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children or animals unattended in the vehicle.
Always keep the key out of reach of children.
Rshift
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is placed in direct
sunlight, the parts could become very hot.
Children could be suffer burns by touching
these parts, in particular on the metallic parts
of the child restraint system. There is a risk of
injury.
If you and your child leave the vehicle, always
make sure that the child restraint system is
not in direct sunlight. Cover it with a blanket,
for example. If the child restraint system has
been exposed to direct sunlight, leave it to
cool down before securing the child in it.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, secure
the child using a child restraint system which
is appropriate to the size, age and weight of
the child. In order to correctly secure the child
in the child restraint system, always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions. You should preferably fit the restraint system to a suitable
rear seat. Make sure that the child is secured
for the trip.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
the listed child restraint systems
(Y page 59). You can obtain further information about the correct child restraint system from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems.
You can obtain information about this at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
G WARNING
If the front-passenger front airbag is not disabled:
Ra
child secured in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat could be seriously or even fatally injured by the frontpassenger airbag deploying. This is especially a risk if the child is in the immediate
vicinity of the front-passenger front airbag
when it deploys.
Rnever secure a child on the front-passenger
seat in a rearward-facing child restraint system. Only secure a rearward-facing child
restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
Rand you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible. When doing so,
ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the
belt outlet on the vehicle is routed towards
the front to the shoulder belt guide on the
child restraint system. Set the belt height
adjustment so that the belt strap is routed
towards the front along the bottom.
Children in the vehicle
Ron
vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat,
unless a child restraint system with transponders for automatic child seat recognition is fitted to the front-passenger seat
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat, if the
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp is not lit.
To make you aware of this danger, a corresponding warning sticker has been affixed to
the side of the dashboard and on both sides of
the sun visor on the front-passenger side.
Information about recommended child
restraint systems is available at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG in
front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the
CHILD can occur.
Automatic child seat recognition on the
front-passenger seat
G WARNING
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up when the child
restraint system is fitted, the front-passenger
front airbag has not been disabled. If the frontpassenger front airbag deploys, the child
could be seriously or even fatally injured.
Proceed as follows:
Rdo not use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
a rearward-facing child restraint system
on a suitable rear seat.
Rfit
or
Ronly
Warning notice on the front-passenger sun visor
use a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat and
move the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. When doing so, ensure that the
shoulder belt strap from the belt outlet on
the vehicle is routed towards the front to
the shoulder belt guide on the child
restraint system. Set the belt height adjustment so that the belt strap is routed
towards the front along the bottom.
Rhave the automatic child seat recognition
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
To ensure that the automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat functions/communicates correctly, never place
objects, e.g. a cushion, under the child
restraint system. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion. An incorrectly fitted child restraint
system cannot perform its intended protective function in the event of an accident, and
could lead to injuries.
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
Z
Safety
The front-passenger front airbag is not disabled:
53
54
Children in the vehicle
Safety
G WARNING
Electronic devices on the front-passenger
seat can affect the function of the automatic
child seat recognition, for example:
Rlaptop
Rmobile
phone
cards such as ski passes or
access passes
The front-passenger front airbag could deploy
unintentionally or not function as intended
during an accident. This poses an increased
risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Do not place any of the devices mentioned
above or similar devices on the frontpassenger seat.
Rtransponder
: PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
The sensor system for child restraint systems
in the front-passenger seat detects whether a
special Mercedes-Benz child seat with a
transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted. In this case,
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp :
lights up. The front-passenger front airbag is
disabled.
i If the front-passenger front airbag is dis-
abled by the automatic child seat recognition, the following remain enabled on the
front-passenger side:
Rthe
sidebag
windowbag
Rthe belt tensioner
Rthe
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle is
not equipped with automatic child seat recognition, this is indicated by a special sticker.
The sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard on the front-passenger side. The
sticker is visible when you open the frontpassenger door.
Vehicles without automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: if you turn
the key to position 2 in the ignition lock, the
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up briefly. However, the indicator lamp
has no function. It does not indicate that there
is automatic child seat recognition on the
front-passenger seat.
ISOFIX child seat securing system for
the rear seats
G WARNING
ISOFIX child restraint systems do not offer
sufficient protective effect for children whose
weight is greater than 22 kg who are secured
using the safety belt integrated in the child
restraint system. The child could, for example,
not be restrained correctly in the event of an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
If the child weighs more than 22 kg, only use
ISOFIX child restraint systems with which the
child is also secured with the vehicle seat belt.
Also secure the child restraint system with the
Top Tether belt, if available.
Children in the vehicle
G WARNING
The child restraint system cannot perform its
protective function if it is not correctly fitted
to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when securing a child
restraint system, always observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the
correct use of the child restraint system.
For safety reasons, on the rear seats use only
child restraint systems with an ISOFIX child
seat securing system which have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
An incorrectly fitted child restraint system
could come loose and seriously or even fatally
injure the child or other vehicle occupants.
When fitting the child restraint system, always
make sure that it is engaged correctly in the
ISOFIX securing rings on both sides.
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. ISOFIX securing rings : for
two ISOFIX child restraint systems are fitted
on the left and right of the rear seats.
Safety
When installing a child restraint system, be
sure to observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the instructions for correct use of the child restraint system.
Top Tether
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Always engage the rear seat backrests in an
upright position before installing the Top
Tether belt. Push and pull the rear seat backrests to check whether they are engaged correctly. The rear seat backrest may fold down if
it is not engaged correctly. The child restraint
system is then no longer supported correctly
or held in position and can no longer perform
its intended function. This can cause serious
or even fatal injuries.
! When fitting the ISOFIX child restraint
system, make sure that the seat belt for the
centre seat does not get trapped. Otherwise, the seat belt could be damaged.
X
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system on
both ISOFIX securing rings :. Comply with
the child restraint system manufacturer's
instructions when installing the ISOFIX
child restraint system.
55
Example: Top Tether belt with one belt strap
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the ISOFIX child restraint system
secured with ISOFIX and the rear seat. It
Z
Safety
56
Children in the vehicle
helps reduce the risk of injury even further. If
the child restraint system is fitted with Top
Tether, this should always be used.
The Top Tether anchorage points are fitted in
the rear compartment behind the outer head
restraints on the parcel shelf.
X Press down the rear of cover ; in the
direction of the arrow.
Cover ; is raised slightly at the front.
X Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
X Top Tether belt with one belt strap: route
Top Tether belt A centrally over head
restraint :.
X Top Tether belt with two belt straps:
route Top Tether belts A on the left and
right past the side of head restraint :.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether
anchorage =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Always comply with the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so. Make sure
that Top Tether belt A is tight.
Vehicles for Australia: there is an additional
Top Tether anchorage point behind the central rear seat.
Children in the vehicle
57
Only child restraint systems which are approved in accordance with the ECE standard ECE R44
are permitted for use in the vehicle.
Suitability of the seats for attaching belted child restraint systems
Key to the letters used in the table:
X
U
Seat which is unsuitable for children in this weight category
Suitable for child restraint systems in the "Universal" category that are approved for use
in this weight category
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category
and are approved for use in this weight category
L Suitable for child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of "Recommended child restraint systems" (Y page 59). Suitable for semi-universal child restraint
systems if the vehicle and the seat are listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's
vehicle model list.
Seat positions
Weight catego- Front-passenger seat
ries
FrontFrontpassenger
passenger
front airbag is front airbag is
not disabled
disabled
Rear seat1
Left, right
Centre
Category 0: up
to 10 kg
X
L2, 3
U, L
U, L4
Category 0+:
up to 13 kg
X
L2, 3
U, L
U, L4
UF3, L3
U, L
U, L4
Category I: 9 to UF3, L3
18 kg
If you use a baby car seat from category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system from category I
on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat does not touch the
rearward-facing child restraint.
2 Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: a child restraint system from the
"Universal" category with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition must be fitted. The PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
3 Move the front-passenger seat as far back as possible. If you secure a child in a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat, ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the belt outlet on the vehicle is
routed towards the front to the shoulder belt guide on the child restraint system. Set the belt height adjustment so that the belt strap is routed towards the front along the bottom. Move the front-passenger seat to the
highest position and move the backrest to an almost vertical position. When doing so, ensure that the complete surface of the child restraint system rests against the backrest of the front-passenger seat and that the
child restraint system does not touch the roof. To do so, you may have to adjust the backrest down a little. For
seats with electrical adjustment, the seat cushion angle must be set to the highest and most upright position.
4 Child restraint systems with a supporting bracket are not suitable for this seat.
1
Z
Safety
Suitable positioning of the child restraint systems
Children in the vehicle
58
Safety
Seat positions
Weight catego- Front-passenger seat
ries
FrontFrontpassenger
passenger
front airbag is front airbag is
not disabled
disabled
Rear seat1
Left, right
Centre
Category II: 15
to 25 kg
UF3, L3
U3, L3
U, L
X
Category III:
22 to 36 kg
UF3, 5, L3, 5
UF3, 5, L3, 5
U, L5
X
Example: approval label on the child restraint system
"Universal" category child restraint systems can be recognised by their orange approval label
and the text "Universal".
"Universal" category child restraint systems can be used on the seats indicated with U, UF or
IUF according to the tables "Suitability of the seats for attaching belted child restraint systems"
or "Suitability of the seats for attaching an ISOFIX child restraint system".
Semi-universal child restraint systems are indicated by the text "Semi-universal" on the
approval label. These can be used if the vehicle and the seat are listed in the child restraint
system manufacturer's vehicle model list. For more information, contact the child restraint
system manufacturer or visit their website.
Suitability of the seats for attaching ISOFIX child restraint systems
If you use a baby car seat from category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system from category I
on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat does not touch the
rearward-facing child restraint.
3 Move the front-passenger seat as far back as possible. If you secure a child in a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat, ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the belt outlet on the vehicle is
routed towards the front to the shoulder belt guide on the child restraint system. Set the belt height adjustment so that the belt strap is routed towards the front along the bottom. Move the front-passenger seat to the
highest position and move the backrest to an almost vertical position. When doing so, ensure that the complete surface of the child restraint system rests against the backrest of the front-passenger seat and that the
child restraint system does not touch the roof. To do so, you may have to adjust the backrest down a little. For
seats with electrical adjustment, the seat cushion angle must be set to the highest and most upright position.
5 For certain child restraint systems in this weight category, this can mean that the area of use is restricted as
the maximum size setting of the child restraint system is not possible due to possible contact with the roof.
1
Children in the vehicle
59
Key to the letters used in the table:
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal"
category, which are approved for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of
"Recommended child restraint systems" (Y page 59).
The manufacturer will also recommend a suitable ISOFIX child restraint system. For this,
your vehicle and the seat must be listed in the child restraint system manufacturer's
model list. For more information, contact the child restraint system manufacturer or visit
their website.
Weight categories
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat, left and
right1
Carry-cot
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
0: up to 10 kg
up to approximately
6 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
0+: up to 13 kg
up to approximately
15 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL6, 7
I: 9 to 18 kg
between approximately 9 months and
4 years
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL6, 7
B
ISO/F2
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
IUF
Recommended child restraint systems
When installing a child restraint system without a transponder for automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat:
X
Move the front-passenger seat as far back as possible.
If you use a baby car seat from category 0 or 0+ or a rearward-facing child restraint system from category I
on a rear seat, you must adjust the driver's or front-passenger seat so that the seat does not touch the
rearward-facing child restraint.
6 Vehicles with the Style or Urban package or 4-way or 6-way front seats: set the front seat to the highest
position.
7 Vehicles with 2-way front seats: set the front seat to the foremost position.
1
Z
Safety
X
60
Children in the vehicle
Safety
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
ensure that the shoulder belt strap from the belt outlet on the vehicle is routed towards the
front to the shoulder belt guide on the child restraint system. Set the belt height adjustment
so that the belt strap is routed towards the front along the bottom.
Weight catego- Manufacries
turer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order num- Automatic
ber
child seat
(A 000 ...)
recognition
Colour
code: 9H95
Category 0: up
to 10 kg
up to approximately
6 months
Britax
Römer
BABY
SAFE plus
03 301146
04 301146
970 10 00
BABY
SAFE plus
II
04 301146
970 20 00
Category 0+:
up to 13 kg
up to approximately
15 months
Britax
Römer
BABY
SAFE plus
03 301146
04 301146
970 10 00
BABY
SAFE plus
II
04 301146
970 20 00
Category I: 9 to
18 kg
between
approximately
9 months and
4 years
Britax
Römer
DUO plus
03 301133
04 301133
970 11 00
Yes
970 16 00
No
04 301133
970 21 00
Yes
Group II/III: 15
to 36 kg
between
approximately
4and 12 years
Britax
Römer
04 301198
970 18 00
Yes
970 19 00
No
970 22 00
Yes
KIDFIX
Yes
Yes
Suggested "Universal"/"Semi-Universal" category ISOFIX child restraint systems:
Weight
categories
Size category
Manufacturer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order
number
Colour
code:
9H95
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Carry-cot
F
–
–
–
–
–
G
–
–
–
–
–
Weight
categories
Size category
Manufacturer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order
number
Colour
code:
9H95
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Category
0:
up to
10 kg
E
–
–
–
–
–
Category
0+:
up to
13 kg
E
Britax
Römer
BABY SAFE 03 301146 B6 6 86
plus
04 301146 8224
No
D
–
–
–
–
–
C
–
–
–
–
–
Category D
I:
C
9 to 18 kg
B
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Britax
Römer
DUO plus
03 301133 A 000 970
04 301133 11 00
Yes
A 000 970
16 00
No
04 301133 A 000 970
21 00
Yes
–
–
B1
A
–
–
–
Z
61
Safety
Children in the vehicle
62
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Problems with automatic child seat recognition
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp on the centre console is lit.
A special Mercedes-Benz child restraint system with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted to the
front-passenger seat. The front-passenger front airbag has therefore been disabled as desired.
The PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp on the centre console is lit.
or
The 6 SRS warning
lamp lights up and/or
the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp does not light up
briefly when you switch
the ignition on.
G WARNING
There is no child restraint system fitted to the front-passenger
seat. Automatic child seat recognition is malfunctioning.
There is a risk of injury.
X Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat,
e.g.:
Rlaptop
Rmobile phone
Rcards with transponders, such as ski passes or access cards
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is still lit:
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake.
the automatic transmission out of
parking position P.
Rshift the manual transmission into neutral.
Rstart the engine.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
Rshift
children or animals unattended in the vehicle.
Always keep the key out of reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If children are travelling in the vehicle, they
could:
Ropen doors, thus endangering other people
or road users
Rexit the vehicle and be caught by oncoming
traffic
Roperate
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Always activate the child-proof locks and
override feature if children are travelling in the
Driving safety systems
vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Override feature for the rear side windows
Rrear
Safety
You can activate the following child-proof
locks:
Rrear
doors (Y page 63)
side windows (Y page 63)
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
X
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X
To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
63
To activate/deactivate: press button :.
If indicator lamp ; is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
only possible using the switches in the driver's door. If indicator lamp ; is off, operation is possible using the switches in the
rear compartment.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 64)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 64)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST (distance
warning function and adaptive Brake
Assist) (Y page 65)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
(Y page 65)
RAdaptive brake lamps (Y page 68)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 68)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 72)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 72)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 72)
Z
64
Driving safety systems
Safety
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you
are inattentive, the driving safety systems can
neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. Driving safety systems are merely aids designed to assist driving. You are responsible for the distance to
the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and for
braking in good time. Always adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road, weather
and traffic conditions and maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
i The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there
is adequate contact between the tyres and
the road surface. Pay particular attention to
the information regarding tyres, recommended minimum tyre tread depths etc. in
the "Wheels and tyres" section
(Y page 326).
In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General notes
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
The ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out when the engine is running.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 64).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
If ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 265) and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 235).
ABS works from a speed of about
8 km/hupwards, regardless of road-surface
conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces,
even when you only brake gently.
Brakes
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions, and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
BAS (Brake Assist)
General notes
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 64).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
Braking
X
Keep the brake pedal depressed firmly until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
General notes
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST consists of
the adaptive Brake Assist and the distance
warning signal, which are described in the
following.
Distance warning function
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 64).
G WARNING
The distance warning function does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Thus, the distance warning function cannot
provide a warning in all critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
G WARNING
The distance warning function cannot always
clearly identify objects and complex traffic
situations.
In such cases, the distance warning function
may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation; do not rely on the distance warning
function alone.
Rnot
Function
X To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate the distance warning function in the
on-board computer (Y page 224).
If the distance warning function is activated,
the Ä symbol appears in the assistance
graphics display.
The distance warning function can help you to
minimise the risk of a collision with a vehicle
ahead or reduce the effects of such a collision. If the distance warning function detects
that there is a risk of a collision, you will be
warned visually and acoustically. Without
your intervention, the distance warning function cannot prevent a collision.
The distance warning function issues a warning at speeds:
Rof around 30 km/h or more, if, over several
seconds, the distance maintained to the
vehicle travelling in front is insufficient. The
· distance warning lamp then lights up
in the instrument cluster.
Rof around 7 km/h or higher, if you very
quickly approach a vehicle in front. An
intermittent warning tone will then sound,
and the · distance warning lamp will
light up in the instrument cluster.
Z
65
Safety
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems
66
X
Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
Safety
X
Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause the system to display a
warning.
With the help of the radar sensor system, the
distance warning function can detect obstacles that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
Up to a speed of about 70 km/h, the distance
warning function can also react to stationary
obstacles, such as stopped or parked vehicles.
If you approach an obstacle and the distance
warning function detects a risk of a collision,
the system will alert you both visually and
acoustically.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Rnew vehicles or after a service on the COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS system
Please observe the information in the section on running-in the vehicle
(Y page 146).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Rsnow
Adaptive Brake Assist
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion for driving safety systems (Y page 64).
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Adaptive Brake Assist may:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
Rnot intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rto stationary obstacles
Rwhen cornering
As a result, Adaptive Brake Assist may not
intervene in all critical conditions. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause Brake Assist to intervene.
Adaptive Brake Assist aids you in braking during hazardous situations at speeds above
7 km/h and uses the radar sensor system to
evaluate the traffic situation.
With the help of a sensor system, adaptive
Brake Assist can detect obstacles that are in
the path of your vehicle for an extended
period of time.
If you approach an obstacle and adaptive
Brake Assist has detected a risk of collision,
adaptive Brake Assist calculates the braking
force necessary to avoid a collision. If you
apply the brakes forcefully, adaptive Brake
Assist will automatically increase the braking
force to a level suitable for the traffic conditions.
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal
is no longer any danger of a collision
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle
Adaptive Brake Assist is then deactivated.
Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: if adaptive Brake
Assist requires particularly high brake pressure, preventive passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are deployed simultaneously.
Up to vehicle speeds of around 250 km/h,
adaptive Brake Assist is capable of reacting to
moving objects that have already been recognised as such at least once over the period
of observation. Adaptive Brake Assist does
not react to stationary obstacles.
If adaptive Brake Assist is not available due to
a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the
brake system remains available with full
brake boosting effect and BAS.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Rthere
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Rnew vehicles or after a service on the COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS system
Rsnow
Please observe the information in the section on running-in the vehicle
(Y page 146).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
General notes
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is
only available on vehicles with DISTRONIC.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
extends the functionality of COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST with an automatic braking
function. COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS can help you to minimise the risk of a
front-end collision with a vehicle ahead or
reduce the effects of such a collision. If COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS detects
that there is a risk of a collision, you will be
warned visually and acoustically. In critical
situations COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS also initiates automatic braking.
Function
X To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS in the on-board computer
(Y page 224).
If COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is
activated, the Ä symbol appears in the
assistance graphics display.
If the driver's seat belt is fastened, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS can brake
automatically within a speed range of
between 7 km/h and 200 km/h.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS can
also react to stationary obstacles with automatic braking within a speed range of
between 7 km/h and 30 km/h.
Vehicles with PRE-SAFE®: if the automatic
braking function of COLLISION PREVENTION
Z
67
Safety
Driving safety systems
Safety
68
Driving safety systems
ASSIST PLUS intervenes powerfully, preventive passenger protection measures (PRESAFE®) are deployed simultaneously.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning button (Y page 113).
Rdirt
General notes
on the sensors or obscured sensors
or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example, in
multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
Rnew vehicles or after a service on the COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS system
Please observe the information in the section on running-in the vehicle
(Y page 146).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Rsnow
Adaptive brake lamps
The adaptive brake lights warn following traffic in an emergency braking situation:
Rby
means of flashing brake lamps
hazard warning lamps are activated
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly. In
this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
Rthe
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 64).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between the tyres
and the road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. The engine output is also modified to
keep the vehicle on the desired course within
physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 64).
ETS/4ETS traction control is part of ESP®.
ETS brakes the drive wheels individually if
they spin. This enables you to pull away and
accelerate on slippery surfaces, for example
if the road surface is slippery on one side. In
addition, more drive torque is transferred to
the wheel or wheels with traction.
ETS remains active when you deactivate
ESP®.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! When testing the electric parking brake
Characteristics of ESP®
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: switch off the igni-
General notes
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
on a braking dynamometer, switch off the
ignition. Application of the brakes by ESP®
may otherwise destroy the brake system.
tion when the electric parking brake is
being tested using a dynamometer.
Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: function or per-
formance tests may only be carried out on
a 2-axle dynamometer. Before operating
the vehicle on such a dynamometer, please
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
You could otherwise damage the drive train
or the brake system.
! Do not tow vehicles with 4MATIC with the
front or rear axle raised.
Vehicles without 4MATIC: when towing your
vehicle with the front axle raised, it is important that you observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 320).
Vehicles with 4MATIC: when towing your
vehicle with both axles on the ground, it is
important that you observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 321).
ESP® is deactivated if the å ESP® OFF
warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp and the å
ESP® OFF warning lamp are lit continuously,
ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 267) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 235).
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
ECO start/stop function
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP®
was deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated when
the engine is switched on again.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
Important safety notes
You can select between the following states
of ESP®:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated.
is deactivated.
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Z
69
Safety
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems
70
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 64).
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
You can select between the following states
of ESP®:
Rin
Safety
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
You can deactivate or activate ESP® via the
on-board computer.
X To deactivate:(Y page 224).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X
To activate:(Y page 224).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin.
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Rengine
RESP®
is activated.
handling mode is activated.
®
RESP is deactivated.
RSPORT
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
In the following situations, it may be better to
activate SPORT handling mode or deactivate
ESP®:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Ron specially designated roads when the
vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics are desired
Driving in SPORT handling mode or without
ESP® requires an extremely qualified and
experienced driver.
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
Driving safety systems
Rengine
torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels are able to
spin.
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
To activate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up. The
SPORT handling mode message appears
in the multifunction display.
X To deactivate SPORT handling mode:
briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out.
X
To deactivate ESP®: press button : until
the å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up
in the instrument cluster.
The ÷ OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
X To activate ESP®: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷
ESP® ON message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Characteristics of activated SPORT handling mode
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree.
Rtraction control is still activated.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin.
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; nor is it
activated if you brake firmly with assistance from ESP®.
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST is no longer available; nor is it activated if you brake
firmly with assistance from ESP®.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Rengine
ESP® trailer stabilisation
General notes
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, ESP® assists you in this situation. ESP®
slows the vehicle down by braking and limiting the engine output until the vehicle/trailer
combination has stabilised.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If road and weather conditions are poor,
trailer stabilisation will not be able to prevent
Z
Safety
Deactivating/activating ESP®
71
Safety
72
Anti-theft systems
the vehicle/trailer combination from swerving. Trailers with a high centre of gravity can
tip over before ESP® can detect this. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
If your vehicle/trailer combination begins to
lurch, you can only stabilise the vehicle/
trailer combination by depressing the brake
firmly.
ESP® trailer stabilisation is active above
speeds of about 65 km/h.
ESP® trailer stabilisation does not work if
ESP® is deactivated or disabled because of a
malfunction.
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General notes
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 186) and
hill start assist (Y page 149). For further
information, see Driving tips (Y page 171).
STEER CONTROL
General notes
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering
wheel in the direction required for vehicle
stabilisation.
This steering support is provided in particular
if:
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake.
Rthe vehicle starts to skid.
Important safety notes
Important safety notes
No steering support is provided from STEER
CONTROL, if
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
RESP®
tion for driving safety systems (Y page 64).
G WARNING
If EBD has malfunctioned, the rear wheels can
still lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 265) as well as display messages (Y page 237).
is malfunctioning.
steering is faulty.
Power steering will, however, continue to
function.
Rthe
Anti-theft systems
Immobiliser
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
X To activate: remove the key from the ignition lock.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. The engine can
be started by anyone with a valid key that is
left inside the vehicle.
Anti-theft systems
when you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur
if the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for
example.
Priming
Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the tow-away protection
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 60 seconds.
X
X
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately
15 seconds.
X
To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
Deactivating
X
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Rthe
vehicle with the emergency key element
Ra door
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
X To stop the alarm: insert the key into the
ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X Press the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
Unlock the vehicle with the key.
or
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
X
X
Z
Safety
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
73
Anti-theft systems
74
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Safety
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again
Ra door is opened and closed again
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the towaway protection if you lock your vehicle and it:
Ris
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Deactivating
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The interior motion sensor is automatically
deactivated.
Deactivating
Ris
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This
can occur if someone reaches into the vehicle
interior, for example.
Priming
Make sure that:
side windows are closed
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed
Rthe boot lid is closed
Only then is the interior motion sensor
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Rthe
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes several times in
rapid succession.
X Lock the vehicle with the key.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
X
X
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again
door is opened and closed again
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Ra
Rpeople
or animals remain in the vehicle
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof remains open
Rthe
side windows remain open
i UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a
double lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle has
been locked with the key (Y page 84).
Deactivate the interior motion sensor
before you lock the vehicle with the key.
The doors can then be opened from the
Anti-theft systems
75
Safety
inside after the vehicle has been locked
from the outside with the key. Observe the
"Important safety notes" (Y page 83).
Z
76
77
Useful information .............................. 78
Key ....................................................... 78
Doors .................................................... 83
Boot ...................................................... 86
Side windows ...................................... 88
Opening and closing
Panorama sliding sunroof .................. 91
78
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the key,
the key could be unintentionally turned in the
ignition lock. This could cause the engine to
be switched off. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
key. Remove any bulky keyrings before inserting the key into the ignition lock.
! Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the
vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
Key
Do not keep the key:
Important safety notes
Rwith
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rget
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
film
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked with the key,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate
the double lock function by deactivating the
interior motion sensor (Y page 74). The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside. You
can open the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not secured by the child-proof
locks (Y page 63). The anti-theft alarm system
Key
Key functions
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system. This means that only the driver's door
and the fuel filler flap are unlocked when the
vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel on your own.
To change the setting: press and hold
down the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
battery check lamp (Y page 80) flashes
twice.
i If the setting of the locking system is
changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
X
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To open the boot lid
= % To unlock the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press button =.
If you do not open the vehicle within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
vehicle is locked again
anti-theft system is primed again
X To lock centrally: press button :.
Rthe
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
boot lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
Rthe
i When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer (Y page 228).
i You can also set an audible signal to con-
firm that the vehicle has been locked. The
audible signal can be activated and deactivated using the on-board computer
(Y page 229).
X
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X To restore the factory settings: press
and hold down the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes
twice (Y page 80).
X
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 73).
To open the boot lid automatically: press
and hold button ; until the boot lid opens
(Y page 87).
Z
Opening and closing
is triggered if the door is opened from the
inside. Switch off the alarm .
79
Key
80
There are several ways to deactivate the
alarm:
X
Press the % or & button on the key.
or
Opening and closing
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key into the ignition lock.
Removing the emergency key element
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
For further information about:
Runlocking
the driver's door (Y page 85)
Runlocking the boot (Y page 88)
Rlocking the vehicle (Y page 86)
Inserting the emergency key element
X
Push emergency key element ; completely into the key until it engages, and
release catch : is back in its basic position.
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Checking the battery
Key
81
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Replace the battery (Y page 81).
i If the key battery is checked within the
signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
i You can obtain a battery from any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 79).
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contamination.
X First insert the front tabs of battery tray
cover : into the housing; then press to
close it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 79).
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery tray cover : opens.
While doing so, do not hold cover : shut.
X Remove battery tray cover :.
X
Z
Opening and closing
X
82
Key
Problems with the key
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle
using the key.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control
function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle from close range and press the % / & button.
Opening and closing
Problem
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery and replace it if necessary (Y page 81).
X Lock (Y page 85) or unlock (Y page 86) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control
function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle from close range and press the % / & button.
X
The key is faulty.
X Lock (Y page 85) or unlock (Y page 86) the vehicle using the
emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
X
If this does not work:
Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 312).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 316).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The steering lock is mechanically blocked.
X Remove the key and reinsert it into the ignition lock. While doing
this, turn the steering wheel in both directions.
Doors
G WARNING
Important safety notes
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen doors, thereby endangering other per-
sons or road users
Rget out and be struck by oncoming traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, if they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children and animals unattended in the vehicle. Keep the keys out of the reach of children.
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276).
United Kingdom only:
G WARNING
When the double locks are activated, the
doors can no longer be opened from the
inside. People in the vehicle can no longer get
out, e.g. in hazardous situations. There is a
risk of injury.
Therefore, do not leave any people unsupervised in the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance. Do not activate the double lock when
people are in the vehicle.
If the vehicle has been locked with the key,
the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open the doors
from inside the vehicle. You can deactivate
the double lock function by deactivating the
Z
Opening and closing
The on-board voltage is too low.
Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
X
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
83
Doors
Opening and closing
84
interior motion sensor (Y page 74). The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside. You
can open the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they are not secured by the child-proof
locks (Y page 63). The anti-theft alarm system
is triggered if the door is opened from the
inside. Switch off the alarm .
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
i When a door is opened, the side window
on that side opens slightly. When the door
is closed, the side window is raised again.
! The side windows will not open/close if
the battery is discharged or if the side windows have iced up. It will then not be possible to close the door. Do not attempt to
force the door to close. You could otherwise damage the door or the side window.
X
You can open the rear doors from inside the
vehicle if they are not secured by the childproof locks (Y page 63).
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock
function by deactivating the interior motion
sensor (Y page 74). The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. You can open
the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they
are not secured by the child-proof locks
(Y page 63). The anti-theft alarm system is
triggered if the door is opened from the
inside. Switch off the alarm (Y page 73).
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside. This can be useful if you wish
to lock the vehicle before pulling away, for
example.
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and opens.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key, opening a door from the inside will
trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off
the alarm (Y page 73).
X
X
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
If all the doors and the boot lid are closed,
the vehicle locks.
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the key.
For all countries except the United Kingdom:
Doors
Rlocked
with the locking button for the central locking or
Rlocked automatically
Tthe vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had
previously been fully unlocked. Only the door
which has been opened form the inside is
unlocked if only the driver's door had been
previously unlocked.
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle. You can deactivate the double lock
function by deactivating the interior motion
sensor (Y page 74). The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. You can open
the rear doors from inside the vehicle if they
are not secured by the child-proof locks
(Y page 63). The anti-theft alarm system is
triggered if the door is opened from the
inside. Switch off the alarm (Y page 73).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will
be observed if the vehicle has been:
Rlocked
with the locking button for the central locking or
Rlocked automatically
Tthe vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had
previously been fully unlocked. Only the door
which has been opened form the inside is
unlocked if only the driver's door had been
previously unlocked.
Automatic locking feature
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To prime: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X
i If you press one of the two buttons and do
not hear a tone, the relevant setting has
already been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
Rthe vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.
You can also switch the automatic locking
function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 229).
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 73).
Z
Opening and closing
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked.
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the key, opening a door from the inside will
trigger the anti-theft alarm system. Switch off
the alarm (Y page 73).
You can open the rear doors from inside the
vehicle if they are not secured by the childproof locks (Y page 63).
When a locked door is opened from inside the
vehicle, the previous unlocking process will
be observed if the vehicle has been:
85
Boot
86
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 79).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Opening and closing
X
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise as far as it will go to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 79).
X
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key (Y page 79).
i If you lock the vehicle as described above,
X
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key, use the emergency key element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the boot lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 84).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
are still visible. Press down the locking
knobs by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 79).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
the fuel filler flap is not locked. The antitheft alarm system is not primed.
Boot
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk
of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid. Never drive with the boot lid
open.
G WARNING
If persons (particularly children) are exposed
to heat or cold for a prolonged period, there is
a risk of serious or even fatal injuries. Never
Boot
leave persons (particularly children) unattended in the vehicle.
87
Closing
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
can be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 362).
Stow luggage or loads preferably in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276).
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could
otherwise lock yourself out.
The boot lid can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
automatically from outside
Ropened automatically from inside
Runlocked from the inside with the emergency key element
Ropened
Opening and closing manually from
outside
Opening
X
Press the % button on the key.
Pull down the boot lid using handle :.
Let the boot lid drop into the lock.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the &
button on the key.
X
X
Opening automatically from outside
General notes
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 362).
Opening
You can open the boot lid automatically using
the key or the handle in the boot lid.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
or
X If the boot is unlocked, pull the boot lid
handle and release it again immediately.
X
X
Pull handle :.
Raise the boot lid.
Opening automatically from inside
General notes
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
Z
Opening and closing
i The opening dimensions of the boot lid
88
Side windows
i The opening dimensions of the boot lid
can be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 362).
Opening and closing
Opening
Insert suitable tool ;, e.g. a screwdriver,
horizontally on the left-hand side into emergency release slot :.
X Push tool ; evenly in the direction of the
arrow and open the boot lid.
X
You can open the boot lid from the driver's
seat when the vehicle is stationary and
unlocked.
X To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid : until the boot lid opens.
i When you lock the vehicle (Y page 86),
the boot is also locked.
Side windows
Important safety notes
Emergency release
If the boot lid can no longer be opened from
outside the vehicle, use the emergency
release on the inside of the boot lid.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i The opening dimensions of the boot lid
can be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 362).
You can reach the emergency release via the
boot. Fold the rear backrests forward
(Y page 280).
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
G WARNING
If children operate the side windows they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
Activate the override feature for the rear side
windows. When leaving the vehicle, always
take the key with you and lock the vehicle.
Never leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Side windows
89
The side windows are equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts a side window from travelling upwards during the automatic closing
process, the side window opens again automatically. During the manual closing process,
the side window only opens again automatically after the corresponding switch is
released. The automatic reversing feature is
only an aid and is no substitute for your attention when closing a side window.
Front left
Front right
Rear right
Rear left
The reversing function does not react:
:
;
=
?
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
i The side windows cannot be operated
Opening and closing the side windows
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open manually: press and hold the corresponding button.
X To open fully: press the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close manually: pull the corresponding
button and hold it.
X To close fully: pull the button beyond the
point of resistance and release it.
Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation:
press/pull the corresponding switch again.
i If you press/pull the switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling again.
G WARNING
gers
Rwhile resetting
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing, make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If someone
becomes trapped, press the switch to open
the side window again.
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
from the rear when the override feature for
the side windows is activated (Y page 63).
X
i You can continue to operate the side windows after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until the driver's
or front-passenger door is opened.
Z
Opening and closing
Side window reversing feature
Side windows
90
Convenience opening feature
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, the key is used to carry out
the following functions simultaneously:
Runlock
the vehicle
the side windows
Ropen the panorama sliding sunroof and the
roller sunblinds
Opening and closing
Ropen
i The convenience opening feature can
only be operated using the key. The key
must be close to the driver's door handle.
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the panorama sunroof
are in the desired position.
If the roller sunblinds of the panorama sliding sunroof are closed, the roller sunblinds
are opened first.
X Press and hold the % button again until
the panorama sliding sunroof is in the
desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
X
Convenience closing feature
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
the side windows
the panorama sliding sunroof
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof,
you can then close the roller sunblinds.
Rclose
i The key must be close to the driver's door
handle.
Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the panorama sliding
sunroof are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
X
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
Press and hold the & button again until
the roller sunblinds of the panorama sliding
sunroof close.
X To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
X
Resetting the side windows
You must reset each side window if:
Rthe
side window opens again slightly after
being closed fully.
Rthe side window can no longer be fully
opened or closed.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 89).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 89).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly. If
this is not the case, repeat the steps above
again.
X
Panorama sliding sunroof
91
Problems with the side windows
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing function is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
X
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Panorama sliding sunroof
If somebody becomes trapped:
Important safety notes
Rrelease
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
G WARNING
While opening and closing the sliding sunroof,
body parts in close proximity could become
trapped. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that no body parts are in close
proximity during the opening and closing procedures.
the switch immediately, or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening or closing procedure will be stopped.
Rduring
G WARNING
If children operate the sliding sunroof they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
Opening and closing
92
Panorama sliding sunroof
G WARNING
At high speeds the raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers slightly at the rear. This could
trap you or other persons. There is a risk of
injury. Make sure that nobody reaches into
the sweep of the sliding sunroof whilst the
vehicle is in motion.
If somebody becomes trapped, immediately
pull back the sliding sunroof switch. The sliding sunroof lifts during opening.
This means that the reversing function cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The closing process is stopped.
Rduring
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof if
it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
Operating the sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
i Resonance noises can occur in addition to
the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Change the position of the sliding sunroof
or open a side window slightly to reduce or
eliminate these noises.
Sliding sunroof reversing feature
The sliding sunroof is equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If an object blocks or
restricts the sliding sunroof during the closing
process, the sliding sunroof opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing feature is only an aid and is no substitute for your
attention when closing the sliding roof.
G WARNING
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover the last 4 mm of the closing movement
Rduring
resetting
Rwhen closing the sliding sunroof again manually immediately after automatic reversing
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press/pull the 3 switch beyond
the point of resistance, automatic operation is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic operation by
pressing/pulling again.
X
i After opening the sliding sunroof, the
roller sunblind automatically closes
slightly. This reduces drafts in the vehicle
interior.
i If the sliding sunroof is raised at the rear,
it automatically lowers slightly at higher
Panorama sliding sunroof
i You can continue to operate the sliding
sunroof after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until you open a
front door.
i The sliding sunroof cannot be opened if a
roof carrier is fitted. In order to allow ventilation of the vehicle interior, you can raise
the sliding sunroof.
If contact is made with a roof carrier
approved by Mercedes-Benz, the sliding
sunroof lowers slightly but remains raised
at the rear .
Rain-closing feature when the engine is
switched off
The rain-closing feature is only available for
vehicles with a rain sensor.
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock or is removed, the sliding sunroof closes
automatically:
Rif
it starts to rain.
Rat extreme outside temperatures.
Rafter six hours.
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply.
The sliding sunroof remains raised at the rear
in order to allow ventilation of the vehicle
interior.
i If the sliding sunroof is obstructed when
being closed by the rain-closing feature, it
opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature is then deactivated.
Rain-closing feature when driving
The raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers at the rear when driving if it starts to rain.
The sliding sunroof is lowered depending on:
Rthe
road speed and
intensity of the rain
You can manually cancel the automatic closing procedure. Press or pull the 3 switch
in any direction.
To raise the sliding sunroof again, press the
3 switch in direction :. The rain-closing
feature remains activated.
Rthe
Operating the roller sunblinds for the
sliding sunroof
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When opening or closing the roller sunblind
parts of the body could be trapped between
the roller sunblind and the frame or sliding
sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
When opening or closing make sure that no
parts of the body are in the sweep of the roller
sunblind.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The opening/closing process is stopped.
Rduring
The roller sunblinds shield the vehicle interior
from sunlight. The two roller sunblinds can
only be opened and closed together when the
sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof does not close if:
Roller sunblinds reversing feature
Rit
The roller sunblinds are equipped with an
automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts the roller blind during the
closing process, the roller blind opens again
automatically. However, the automatic
reversing feature is only an aid, not a substi-
is raised at the rear.
Rit is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor,
e.g. because the vehicle is under a bridge.
Z
Opening and closing
speeds. The noise level in the vehicle interior is reduced as a result.
At low speeds it raises again automatically.
93
Panorama sliding sunroof
94
tute for your attention when closing the roller
sunblind.
G WARNING
tion. You can stop automatic operation by
pressing/pulling again.
i After opening the sliding sunroof, the
roller sunblind automatically closes
slightly. This reduces drafts in the vehicle
interior.
The reversing function does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
Opening and closing
gers
Rwhen closing the roller sunblind again man-
ually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing function cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the sweep of the roller sunblind.
If someone is trapped:
Rrelease
the switch immediately or
automatic operation, press the
switch briefly in any direction
The closing process is stopped.
Rduring
Opening and closing
Overhead control panel
: To open
; To open
= To close
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press/pull the 3 switch beyond
the point of resistance, automatic operation is started in the corresponding direcX
Resetting the sliding sunroof and the
roller sunblinds
If the sliding sunroof or the roller sunblinds do
not move smoothly, reset the sliding sunroof
and the roller sunblinds:
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow =
until the sliding sunroof is fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow =
until the roller sunblinds are fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Make sure that the sliding sunroof
(Y page 92) and the roller sunblinds
(Y page 94) can be fully opened and closed
again.
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
X
Panorama sliding sunroof
95
Problems with the sliding sunroof
If you do not reset the sliding sunroof after a malfunction or voltage supply interruption, then the
reversing function will malfunction or not work. The sliding sunroof closes with increased or
maximum force. Parts of the body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses
an increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
In such or similar situations always make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
Always reset the sliding sunroof after a malfunction or voltage supply interruption.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The sliding sunroof can- If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and reopens
not be closed and you again slightly:
cannot see the cause. X Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3
switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and
reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3
switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Z
Opening and closing
G WARNING
96
97
Useful information .............................. 98
Correct driver's seat position ............ 98
Seats .................................................... 99
Steering wheel .................................. 104
Mirrors ............................................... 105
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory functions ............................. 107
98
Correct driver's seat position
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Correct driver's seat position
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
X
Make sure that seat = is correctly adjusted.
Manual seat adjustment (Y page 100)
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 100)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
Ryou
are as far away from the driver's airbag as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly.
Ryou have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position.
Ryou have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted correctly (Y page 101).
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by the
centre of the head restraint.
Observe the safety notes on steering wheel
adjustment (Y page 104).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted correctly.
Adjusting the steering wheel
(Y page 104)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.
Ryou
Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 46).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 48).
Observe the safety notes on seat adjustment
(Y page 99).
Seats
Rfit
snugly across your body.
Rbe routed across the middle of your
shoulder.
Rbe routed across your hips in the pelvic
area.
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 105)
so that you have a good view of road and
traffic conditions.
X Vehicles with a memory function: save
the seat and exterior mirror settings
(Y page 107).
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
G WARNING
When adjusting a seat, you or another vehicle
occupant could become trapped by the guide
rail of the seat, for instance. There is a risk of
injury.
Make sure that no one has any part of their
body within the sweep of the seat when
adjusting it.
G WARNING
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children adjust the seats, they could
become trapped, especially if they are unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seatbelt is routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat belt should:
99
Seats
100
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when
moving the seats back. There is a risk that
the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Lift handle : and slide the seat forwards
or rearwards.
X Release lever : again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
X
Backrest angle
Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
X Turn handwheel ? forwards or backwards.
X
Seat height
X
Pull handle = upwards or push it down
repeatedly until the seat has reached the
desired height.
Seat cushion angle
Adjust the angle so that your thighs are lightly
supported.
X Turn handwheel ; forwards or backwards.
Adjusting the seats electrically
i Further related subjects:
RLuggage
compartment enlargement
(folding down the rear seats)
(Y page 279)
Adjusting the seats manually
: Head restraint height8
; Seat cushion angle
= Seat height
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
A Backrest angle
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 107).
8
Not available on vehicles with sports seats.
Seats
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the
direction of the arrow and push the head
restraint down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the head restraint fore-and-aft
position
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
General notes
For vehicles with sports seats you cannot
adjust the front head restraints or the outer
rear head restraints.
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Adjusting the head restraint height
This function allows you to adjust the distance between the head restraint and the
back of the head.
To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards in the direction of the arrow until
it engages.
There are a number of detents.
X To move backwards: press and hold
release button : and push the head
restraint backwards.
X When the head restraint is in the desired
position, release the button and make sure
that the head restraint is engaged in position.
X
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for head restraint adjustment
(Y page 100) up or down in the direction of
the arrow.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the head restraints
101
Seats
102
Rear seat head restraints
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
height
Fold the seat backrest slightly forwards in
order to remove the head restraint
(Y page 280).
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
X
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired height.
X
To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
Removing and fitting the rear seat head
restraints
G WARNING
The head restraints cannot provide the intended protection unless they are fitted and
adjusted correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury to the head and neck in the event of
an accident or sudden braking, for example.
Always drive with the head restraints fitted.
Ensure that the centre of the head restraints
support the back of each vehicle occupant's
head at eye level before driving off.
The rear head restraints on the outer seats
can be removed and refitted. For vehicles
with sports seats the rear head restraints
cannot be removed and refitted.
Electric head restraints cannot be removed.
For more information about removing electric
head restraints, please contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
:
;
=
?
To raise the backrest contour
To soften the backrest contour
To lower the backrest contour
To harden the backrest contour
Seats
To adjust the contour of the seat and for
improved lateral support, you can individually
adjust the front seats.9
Adjusting the side bolsters of the seat
cushion
To set the side bolsters of the seat
cushion narrower: press button :.
X To set the side bolsters of the seat
cushion wider: press button ;.
X
Adjusting the seat backrest side bolsters
To set the side bolsters of the seat
backrest narrower: press button =.
X To set the side bolsters of the seat
backrest wider: press button ?.
X
Switching the seat heating on/off
Therefore, do not switch on the seat heating
repeatedly.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches from level
3 to level 2 after approximately eight
minutes.
The system automatically switches down
from level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten
minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
X
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
G WARNING
If you repeatedly switch on seat heating, the
seat cushion and backrest padding may
become very hot. The health of vehicle occupants with limited temperature sensitivity or a
limited ability to react to excessively high
temperatures may be affected or they may
even suffer burn-like injuries. There is a risk of
injury.
9
Only in conjunction with electrically adjustable seats.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
AMG Performance Seat
103
104
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Problems with the seat heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The seat heating has
switched off prematurely or cannot be
switched on.
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat heating will
switch back on automatically.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle while
driving if you:
Radjust
the driver's seat, steering wheel or
mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirrors and fasten your seat
belt before starting the engine.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped by the steering wheel if they adjust it. There is a risk of
injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Adjusting the steering wheel
G WARNING
The steering wheel may move unexpectedly if
you adjust it while driving. This could cause
you to lose control of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Make sure that the steering wheel is locked
before driving off. Never unlock the steering
wheel when the vehicle is in motion.
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
X
Anti-dazzle mode: pivot anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects visible in the mirrors are
closer than they appear. You could misjudge
the distance from road users driving behind
you when changing lanes, for instance. There
is a risk of an accident.
You should therefore always look over your
shoulder to determine the actual distance
from road users driving behind you.
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, or to
the left or right until you have adjusted the
exterior mirror to the correct position. You
should have a good overview of traffic conditions.
X
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
After the engine has been started, the exterior mirrors are automatically heated at low
outside temperatures. Heating takes a maximum of ten minutes.
i The exterior mirrors can also be heated
manually by switching on the rear window
heating.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Mirrors
105
Mirrors
106
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
i If you are driving faster than 47 km/h, you
can no longer fold in the exterior mirrors.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Resetting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 230).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Briefly press button :.
Folding the exterior mirrors in/out
automatically
button (Y page 105) until you hear a click
and then the mirror engage in position.
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 105).
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
The "Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors" function
is only available if the vehicle is equipped with
the "Mirror package".
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on and
light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror
The mirrors do not go into anti-dazzle mode if
reverse gear is engaged or if the interior lighting is switched on.
Rincident
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 230):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door.
General notes
i If the exterior mirrors have been folded in
Setting and storing the parking position
manually, they do not fold out.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position (forwards or backwards), proceed as
follows:
Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press and hold mirror-folding
X
Parking position of the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side
The "Parking position for the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side" function is only
available if the vehicle is equipped with the
"Memory package".
Using reverse gear
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
Memory functions
107
Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
Calling up a stored parking position setting
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror. You should see the rear
wheel and the kerb in the exterior mirror.
The parking position is stored.
X
X
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
Using the memory button
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
This setting can be stored using memory button M ?.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror. You should see the rear
wheel and the kerb in the exterior mirror.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side with the corresponding button (Y page 105).
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
X
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
Memory functions
Storing settings
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, the adjustments could
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If the memory function adjusts the seat, you
and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Memory functions
108
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any part of
their body within the sweep of the seat. If
someone becomes trapped, immediately
release the memory function position button.
The adjustment is stopped.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
If children activate the memory function, they
could become trapped, especially if they are
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition of the seat, backrest and head
restraint.
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides.
Adjust the seat (Y page 100).
Adjust the exterior mirror on the driver's
side (Y page 105).
X Briefly press the M memory button and
then press storage position button 1, 2 or 3
within three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
X
Calling up a stored setting
X
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat and
exterior mirrors are in the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
109
Useful information ............................ 110
Exterior lighting ................................ 110
Interior lighting ................................. 116
Replacing bulbs ................................. 117
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers ........................... 121
110
Exterior lighting
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Lights and windscreen wipers
ist workshops: (Y page 24).
Exterior lighting
General notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Driving abroad
General notes
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is
registered, your headlamps must be switched
to symmetrical dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border (only vehicles
with Intelligent Light System). This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an
area of the edge of the carriageway.
Vehicles with bi-xenon and halogen
headlamps
It is not necessary to switch your headlamps
to symmetrical dipped beam when driving in
countries where vehicles are driven on the
opposite side of the road to the country in
which the vehicle is registered. Legal require-
ments are fulfilled without switching the
headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam.
Vehicles with Intelligent Light System
X
Before crossing the border, set the headlamps to symmetrical dipped beam and
after returning back to asymmetrical
dipped beam via the "Dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left" function
in the on-board computer (Y page 227).
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
"extended range foglamps" functions are not
available.
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set using the:
Rlight
switch
Rheadlamp range control (vehicles with halogen headlamps only) (Y page 112)
Rcombination switch (Y page 113)
Ron-board computer (Y page 226)
Light switch
Operation
1 W Left-hand parking lamps
2 X Right-hand parking lamps
3 T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
Exterior lighting
led by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
B R Rear foglamp
C N Foglamp (vehicles with front fog-
lamps only)
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X
Turn the light switch to Ã.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
Ropen the driver's door with the key in position 0
Automatic headlamp mode
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the
dipped-beam headlamps may not be switched
on automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle
lighting at all times.
à is the preferred light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
RKey in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
RWith the engine running: if you have
switched on the daytime driving lights function in the on-board computer, the daytime
driving lights or the side lamps and dippedbeam headlamps are switched on or off
automatically depending on the brightness
of the ambient light.
X To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
The daytime driving lights improve the detectability of your vehicle during the day. Here,
the daytime driving lights function must be
switched on via the on-board computer
(Y page 226).
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up and the daytime
driving lights switch off.
Dipped-beam headlamps
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in position L, the side lamps and
dipped-beam headlamps are switched on
even if the light sensor does not sense dark
ambient light conditions. This is advantageous when there is fog or rain.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Foglamps
In conditions where visibility is poor due to
fog, snow or rain, the foglamps improve visibility as well as making it easier for other road
users to see you. They can be operated
together with the side lamps or together with
the side lamps and dipped-beam headlamps.
X To switch on the foglamps: turn the key
in the ignition lock to position 2 or start the
engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
111
Exterior lighting
112
Press the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the front foglamps: press
the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
Lights and windscreen wipers
Only vehicles with front foglamps are equipped with the "Foglamp" function; for how to
operate the foglamps on vehicles with the
Intelligent Light System (Y page 115).
Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp improves the visibility of
your vehicle in heavy fog for the following
traffic. Please observe the country-specific
laws on the use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
i When the rear foglamp is switched on, the
centre brake lamp in the tail lamp switches
off due to a legal requirement.
Side lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable
the next engine start. Always park your
vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according
to legal standards. Avoid the continuous
use of the T side lamps for several
hours. If possible, switch on the X right
or the W left parking lamp.
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Parking lamps
Switching on the parking lamps ensures that
the corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key
is not in the ignition lock or it is in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
Adjusting the headlamp range (halogen
headlamps)
The headlamp range control allows you to
adjust the cone of light from the headlamps to
suit the vehicle load.
Headlamp range control
g Driver's seat and front-passenger seat
occupied
1 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied
2 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied, luggage compartment laden
3 Driver's and front-passenger seats occupied and maximum permissible rear axle
load utilised, e.g. when towing a trailer
X
X
Start the engine.
Turn the headlamp range control to the
position which corresponds to the load in
your vehicle.
Exterior lighting
Combination switch
113
i Vehicles with Adaptive Highbeam Assist:
when Adaptive Highbeam Assist is active, it
controls activation of the main-beam headlamps (Y page 115).
Turn signals
Headlamp flasher
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2, or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
:
;
=
?
Main-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
Headlamp flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
Hazard warning lamps
X
Main-beam headlamps
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
The hazard warning lamps switch on automatically if:
Ran
airbag is deployed or
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of above 70 km/h and comes to a
standstill
X To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
Rthe
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
above 10 km/h again after a full brake application.
i The hazard warning lamps continue to
operate even if the ignition is switched off.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
114
Exterior lighting
Headlamp cleaning system
Cornering light function
If the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is
operated five times (Y page 121) while the
lights are on and the engine is running, the
headlamps are cleaned automatically. When
you switch off the ignition, the automatic
headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is resumed from 0.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Intelligent Light System
General notes
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit
the prevailing driving and weather conditions.
It offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending
on the vehicle speed or weather conditions.
The system includes the active light function,
cornering light function, motorway mode and
extended range foglamps. The system is only
active when it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" using the on-board computer
(Y page 227).
Active light function
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. The cornering light function can only be activated when
the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h
and switch on the turn signal or turn the
steering wheel
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
70 km/h or switch off the turn signal or turn
the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position
The cornering lamp may remain lit for a short
time, but is automatically switched off after
no more than three minutes.
Motorway mode
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
driving. This allows you to recognise pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
Exterior lighting
Motorway mode increases the range of the
beam.
Active:
Rif
you are driving at speeds above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering movements for at least 1000 m
Rif you are driving at speeds above
130 km/h
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it
switches on the main-beam headlamps again.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Extended range foglamps
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp.
Not active: if, following activation, you are
driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you
switch off the rear foglamp.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not recognise
road users:
Rwho
have no lights, e.g. pedestrians
have poor lighting, e.g. cyclists
Rwhose lighting is blocked, e.g. by a barrier
In very rare cases, Adaptive Highbeam Assist
recognises road users too late or not at all. In
this, or in similar situations, the automatic
main-beam headlamps will not be deactivated
or activated regardless. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always carefully observe the traffic conditions
and switch off the main-beam headlamps in
good time.
Rwho
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
General notes
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
115
Z
Interior lighting
116
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You
are responsible for adjusting the vehicle's
lighting to the prevailing light, visibility and
traffic conditions.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be restricted if there is:
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
Lights and windscreen wipers
snow
Rdirt on the sensors or if the sensors are
obscured
Headlamps misted up on the inside
Under certain climatic and physical conditions, moisture may form in the headlamp.
This moisture will not impair the function of
the headlamp.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
on/off
To switch on: turn the light switch to Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display lights up when it is dark and the
light sensor activates the dipped-beam
headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above 25 km/h:
The headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above approximately 30 km/h and no other road users
are recognised:
The main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below 25 km/h
or other road users are recognised or the
roads are adequately lit:
The main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To switch off: move the combination
switch back to its normal position or move
the light switch to another position.
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
Front overhead control panel
: p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
; c Switches the front interior lighting
on
= v Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
? | Switches the front interior lighting/
automatic interior lighting control off
A p Switches the right-hand front read-
ing lamp on/off
B Switches the automatic interior lighting
control on
Replacing bulbs
117
Manual interior lighting control
To switch the front interior lighting on:
set the switch to the c position.
X To switch off the interior lighting: set the
switch to the | position or (if the door is
closed) to the centre position.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on/
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
X
: p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
lamp on/off
Interior lighting control
Important notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
The brightness of the ambient lighting may be
set using the on-board computer
(Y page 227).
Automatic interior lighting control
X
To switch on: set the switch to centre
position B.
X
To switch off: set the switch to the |
position.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior lighting is activated for a short
time when the key is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed
switch-off using the on-board computer
(Y page 228).
Ropen
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
G DANGER
Xenon bulbs are under high voltage. You can
get an electric shock if you remove the cover
of the xenon bulb and touch the electrical
contacts. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Never touch the parts or the electrical contacts of the xenon bulb. Always have work on
the xenon bulbs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
If your vehicle is equipped with xenon bulbs,
you can recognise this by the following: the
cone of light from the xenon bulbs moves
from the top to the bottom and back again
when you start the engine. For this to be
observed, the lights must be switched on
before the engine is started.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
on/off
; p Switches the right-hand reading
118
Replacing bulbs
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Other bulbs
G WARNING
Bulbs, lamps and plug connectors can
become very hot during use. When replacing a
bulb, you could burn yourself on these components. There is a risk of injury.
Allow these components to cool down before
replacing the bulb.
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Overview of bulb replacement – bulbs
You can replace the following bulbs. The
details for the bulb type can be found in the
legend.
Do not use a bulb that has been dropped or if
its glass tube has been scratched.
The bulb may explode if:
Ryou
touch it
is hot
Ryou drop it
Ryou scratch it
Only operate bulbs in enclosed lamps
designed for that purpose. Only fit spare
bulbs of the same type and the specified voltage.
Marks on the glass tube reduce the service
life of the bulbs. Do not touch the glass tube
with your bare hands. If necessary, clean the
glass tube when cold with alcohol or spirit and
rub it off with a lint-free cloth.
Protect bulbs from moisture during operation. Do not allow bulbs to come into contact
with liquids.
There are bulbs other than the xenon bulbs
that you cannot replace yourself. Replace
only the bulbs listed (Y page 118). Have the
bulbs that you cannot replace yourself
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance replacing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
Rit
Vehicles with halogen headlamps
: Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W
; Main-beam headlamp/daytime driving
lamp/side lamp/parking lamp:
H15 55 W/15 W
= Dipped-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
Vehicles with Intelligent Light System
: Cornering lamp: H7 55 W
Replacing bulbs
119
Tail lamps (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
: Rear foglamp: P 21 W
; Brake lamp: W 16 W
= Brake lamp: W 16 W
? Turn signal lamp: PY 21 W
A Reversing lamp: W 16 W
Replacing the front bulbs
Fitting/removing the cover on the front
wheel arch
You must remove the cover from the front
wheel housing before you can change the
front bulbs.
Remove the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 119).
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X Replace the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 119).
X
Main-beam headlamps/daytime driving
lights/side lamps and parking lamps
(vehicles with halogen headlamps)
To remove: switch off the lights.
Turn the front wheels inwards.
X Turn rotary knob : through 90°.
Cover ; is released.
X Push cover ; down.
X To fit: push cover ; up.
X Turn rotary knob : through 90°.
Cover ; is locked.
X
X
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Dipped-beam headlamps (halogen
headlamps)
Replacing bulbs
120
Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb ; anti-clockwise and pull it out.
X Insert the new bulb and engage it to the
stop.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
Lights and windscreen wipers
Turn signal lamp (halogen headlamps)
Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
Replacing the rear bulbs
Opening and closing the side trim panels
You must open the side trim panel in the boot
before you can replace the bulbs in the tail
lamps.
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn bulb holder : anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder :.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder :.
X Insert bulb holder : and turn it clockwise
until it engages.
X
X
Cornering lamps (Intelligent Light System)
Example: right-hand side trim panel
To open: release right or left side trim
panel : at the top and fold it down in the
direction of the arrow.
X To close: insert side panel :.
X
Tail lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 120).
X
X
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
Windscreen wipers
121
Windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
Press retaining clips : at the same time in
the direction of the arrows.
X Carefully remove the bulb holder with the
contacted connectors and the bulbs.
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen wipers in dry weather conditions,
always operate them using washer fluid.
X
Bulb holder
: Brake lamp
; Brake lamp
= Rear foglamp
? Reversing lamp
A Turn signals
Brake lamp/rear foglamp/reversing
lamp: remove the corresponding bulb from
the bulb holder.
X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder.
X Turn signal lamp: lightly press the bulb
into the bulb holder, turn it anti-clockwise
and remove it from the bulb holder.
X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and
turn it clockwise.
X Reinsert the bulb holder and engage on
retaining clips :.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 120).
X
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
set to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î to wipe the wind-
screen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
122
Windscreen wipers
windscreen may be damaged by the force
of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
! Vehicles with a rain sensor: if the wind-
Lights and windscreen wipers
screen becomes dirty in dry weather conditions, the windscreen wipers may be activated inadvertently. This could damage the
windscreen wiper blades or scratch the
windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or
Å position, the appropriate wiping frequency is automatically set according to the
intensity of the rain. In the Å position, the
rain sensor is more sensitive than in the Ä
position, causing the windscreen wipers to
wipe more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windscreen
will no longer be wiped properly. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions.
Replacing the windscreen wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can be
trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
Press both release clips ;.
Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = away from wiper arm ?.
X Remove wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow A.
X
X
Fitting the wiper blades
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the windscreen wiper arm without a wiper
blade and it falls onto the windscreen, the
Position new wiper blade : with recess B
on lug A.
X Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = onto the wiper arm, until retaining
clips ; engage in bracket ?.
X
Windscreen wipers
123
Make sure that wiper blade : is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Z
124
Windscreen wipers
Problems with the windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Lights and windscreen wipers
The windscreen wipers Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windscreen
are jammed.
wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
fail completely.
X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The windscreen washer The spray nozzles are misaligned.
fluid from the spray
X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist worknozzles no longer hits
shop.
the centre of the windscreen.
125
Useful information ............................ 126
Overview of climate control systems ................................................... 126
Operating the climate control system ..................................................... 130
Climate control
Adjusting the air vents ..................... 143
126
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 24).
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up.
To prevent the windows from misting up:
Rswitch
Rswitch
briefly
Rswitch
off climate control only briefly
on air-recirculation mode only
on the cooling with air dehumidification function
Rswitch on the "demist windscreen" function
briefly, if required
THERMATIC automatic climate control/
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
regulates the temperature and the humidity
of the vehicle interior and filters out undesirable substances from the air.
THERMATIC automatic climate control/
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control is
only operational when the engine is running.
Optimum operation is only achieved with the
side windows and panorama sliding sunroof
closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition
switched off (Y page 137).
Always keep the ventilation flaps behind the
side panelling clear (Y page 120). Otherwise,
the vehicle will not be ventilated correctly.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 90). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most par-
ticles of dust and soot and completely filters out pollen. With THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control, gaseous pollutants
and odours will also be reduced. A clogged
filter reduces the amount of air supplied to
the vehicle interior. For this reason, you
should always observe the interval for
replacing the filter, which is specified in the
Service Booklet. As this depends on environmental conditions, e.g. heavy air pollution, the interval may be shorter than stated
in the Service Booklet.
i It is possible that the residual heat func-
tion may be activated automatically an hour
after the key has been removed in order to
dry the automatic climate control. The vehicle is then ventilated for 30 minutes.
Overview of climate control systems
127
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
To set the temperature (Y page 132)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 134)
To set the air distribution (Y page 133)
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 136)
To set the airflow (Y page 133)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 130)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 135)
Notes on using THERMATIC automatic
climate control
automatic climate control
The following contains notes and recommendations on optimum use of THERMATIC automatic climate control.
RSwitch on the air-conditioning system by
turning control knob A clockwise to the
desired position (except position 0).
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
RRecommendation for avoiding misted
windows at low exterior temperatures
or in rain: switch on the ¿ cooling with
dehumidification function (Y page 130).
Set air distribution to ¯ and if possible
switch off P and O (Y page 133).
Deactivate air-recirculation mode e
(Y page 136).
Set airflow control A to a setting between
3 and 6 (Y page 133).
RRecommendation for rapid cooling or
heating of the vehicle interior: briefly set
airflow control A to a setting between 3
and 6 (Y page 133).
RRecommendation for a constant vehicle interior temperature: set airflow control A to a setting between 1 and 3
(Y page 133).
RRecommendation for air distribution in
winter: select the O and ¯ settings
(Y page 133).
Recommendation for air distribution in
summer: select the P or P and
¯ settings (Y page 133).
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" function briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
Climate control
Control panel for THERMATIC automatic climate control
128
Overview of climate control systems
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
Climate control
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RVehicles with COMAND Online: if you
change the settings of the climate control
system, the climate status display appears
for three seconds at the bottom of the
screen in the COMAND display. See also
the separate COMAND Online operating
instructions. You will see the current settings of the various climate control functions.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 151).
Overview of climate control systems
129
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
To set the temperature, left (Y page 132)
To set climate control to automatic mode (Y page 132)
To demist the windscreen (Y page 134)
To increase the airflow (Y page 133)
To set the air distribution (Y page 133)
Display
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 136)
To switch climate control on/off (Y page 130)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 132)
To activate/deactivate the residual heat function (Y page 137)
To activate/deactivate cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 130)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 133)
To switch the rear window heating on/off (Y page 135)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 133)
Notes on using THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the
à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the "Windscreen demisting" func-
tion briefly until the windscreen is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn into
the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp in the á button goes out.
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
Operating the climate control system
130
RUse the residual heat function if you want to
Climate control
heat or ventilate the vehicle interior when
the ignition is switched off. The residual
heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition switched off.
RVehicles with COMAND Online: if you
change the settings of the climate control
system, the climate status display appears
for three seconds at the bottom of the
screen in the COMAND display. See also
the separate COMAND Online operating
instructions. You will see the current settings of the various climate control functions.
ECO start/stop function
During automatic engine switch-off, the climate control only operates at a reduced capacity. If you require the full climate control output, you can switch off the ECO start/stop
function by pressing the ECO button
(Y page 151).
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
i THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: switch on climate control primarily
using the à button.
Activating/deactivating the cooling
with air dehumidification function
Operating the climate control system
General notes
Switching climate control on/off
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function briefly.
The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is only available when the engine is running. The air inside the vehicle is cooled and
dehumidified according to the temperature
selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This
is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
General notes
When the climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. The windows could mist up.
Therefore, only switch off climate control
briefly.
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To switch on: turn control A clockwise to
the desired position (except position 0)
(Y page 127).
X To switch off: turn control A anti-clockwise to position 0 (Y page 127).
X
Operating the climate control system
131
Activating/deactivating
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
Climate control
X
Operating the climate control system
132
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in
the ¿ button
flashes three times or
goes out. The cooling
with air dehumidification system cannot be
switched on.
Cooling with air dehumidification has been deactivated due to a
malfunction.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Climate control
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
General notes
Only THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control features the "Control climate control
automatically" function.
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally
when the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated. If desired, cooling with
air dehumidification can be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can mist up more quickly. Therefore,
only deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function briefly.
X
To switch to manual mode: press the
É or Ë button.
or
X
Press the K or I button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are deactivated.
Setting the temperature
THERMATIC automatic climate control
You can set the temperature for the entire
vehicle.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To increase/reduce: turn control :
clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 127).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To increase/reduce: turn control : or E
clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 129).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
X
Operating the climate control system
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed if the adjusters are turned clockwise
until they engage.
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
i You can also activate several of the air
distribution settings simultaneously. In
order to do this, press several of the air
distribution buttons. The air is then routed
through different air vents.
Setting the air distribution
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press one or more of the P, O, ¯
buttons.
The corresponding indicator lamp comes
on.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs airflow through the centre and
side air vents as well as the footwell air
vents10
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister vents10
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
10 Only
for certain countries.
Setting the air distribution
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press the É or Ë button repeatedly
until the desired symbol appears in the display.
X
Setting the airflow
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To increase/reduce: turn control A
clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 127).
X
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To increase/reduce: press the K or
I button.
X
Switching the ZONE function on/off
This function is only available with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
X To activate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
X
To deactivate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
Climate control
Setting the air distribution
133
Operating the climate control system
134
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger
side.
Demisting the windscreen
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
X
or
X
i You should only select the "Windscreen
demisting" function until the windscreen is
clear again.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
THERMATIC automatic climate control:
turn temperature control : clockwise or
anti-clockwise (Y page 127).
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: turn temperature control : or E
clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 129).
Climate control
X
Rhigh
airflow
temperature
Rair distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
i The "Windscreen demisting" function
automatically sets the blower output to the
optimum demisting effect. As a result, the
airflow may increase or decrease automatically after the button is pressed.
Rhigh
i You can adjust the blower output man-
ually while the "Windscreen demisting"
function is in operation:
RTHERMATIC automatic climate control:
turn airflow control A clockwise or anticlockwise (Y page 127).
RTHERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: press the ó or ô button.
X To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
THERMATIC automatic climate control
X Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
X Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the ¬ "Windscreen demisting" function.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Set the air distribution to P or O.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
X
Operating the climate control system
135
Rear window heating
General notes
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. It otherwise
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
Climate control
X
Operating the climate control system
136
Problems with the rear window heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot
be activated.
The battery has not been sufficiently charged.
X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading
lamps, interior lighting or the seat heating.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating can be activated again.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
Climate control
General notes
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
If you switch on air-recirculation mode, the
windows can mist up more quickly, in particular at low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation mode briefly to prevent the windows
misting up.
The operation of air-recirculation mode is the
same for all control panels.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To activate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up.
X
i Air-recirculation mode is activated auto-
matically at high outside temperatures.
When air-recirculation mode is activated
automatically, the indicator lamp in the
e button is not lit. Outside air is added
after about 30 minutes.
X
To deactivate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode is deactivated
automatically:
Rafter
approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below about 5 †
Rafter approximately five minutes if the
"Cooling with air dehumidification" function is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
5 † if the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is activated
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
When the convenience closing feature is operating, parts of the body could become trapped
in the closing area of the side window and the
sliding sunroof. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. When closing make sure that no parts of
the body are in the closing area.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
When opening, make sure that nobody is
touching the side window. If someone
becomes trapped, press the W switch
immediately to open/close the side window
Operating the climate control system
they will remain in this position when
opened using the convenience opening feature.
in the door. The side window stops. To continue closing the side window, pull on the
W switch.
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the e button until the side windows and the panorama sliding sunroof are
closed.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
If parts of the body are in the closing area
during convenience closing, proceed as follows:
To open/close the side window, press the
W button.
The side window stops.
X To then open the side window, press the
W button again.
or
X Press and hold the e button again for at
least two seconds.
The side windows move in the opposite
direction.
X Press the 3 button for opening/closing
the panorama sliding sunroof.
The panorama sliding sunroof stops.
X To then open the panorama sliding sunroof,
pull back on the 3 switch.
i Notes on the automatic reversing function for:
X
Rthe
side window (Y page 89)
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof
(Y page 92)
X Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the e button until the side windows and the panorama sliding sunroof
have opened. The side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof move back to
their original position.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows or the panorama sliding sunroof manually after closing with the convenience closing feature,
Activating/deactivating the residual
heat function
General notes
The residual heat function is only available
with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the vehicle
for approximately 30 minutes after the engine
has been switched off. The heating time
depends on the set interior temperature.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
i If you activate the residual heat function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
i You cannot use the ventilation to cool the
vehicle interior to a temperature lower than
the outside temperature.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it (Y page 147).
X To activate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
X
i Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rwhen the auxiliary heating is switched on
Rwhen
Z
Climate control
X
137
138
Operating the climate control system
Auxiliary heating/ventilation
Climate control
Important safety notes
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or sufficient
ventilation is not possible, toxic exhaust
fumes can enter the vehicle, especially carbon monoxide. This is the case, e.g. in
enclosed spaces, or if the vehicle is stuck in
snow. There is a risk of fatal injuries.
You should switch off the auxiliary heating in
enclosed spaces which do not have an extraction system, e.g. a garage. If the vehicle is
stuck in snow and you must leave the auxiliary
heating running, keep the exhaust pipe and
the area around the vehicle clear of snow. To
guarantee a sufficient supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle away from
the wind.
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle, e.g. the exhaust system,
can become very hot. Flammable materials,
e.g. leaves, grass or branches, may ignite if
they come into contact with hot parts of the
exhaust system. There is a risk of fire.
Make sure no flammable materials come into
contact with hot vehicle parts when the auxiliary heating is switched on.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle interior to the set temperature. This
occurs without using the heat of the running
engine. The auxiliary heating is operated
directly using the vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the fuel tank must be at least ¼ full to
ensure that the auxiliary heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off when the
engine is switched off. The auxiliary ventilation switches off when you turn the key to key
position 2 (Y page 147).
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically after 30 minutes.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
Before switching on
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Set the desired temperature.
X
Auxiliary heating or ventilation can also be
switched on if the manually set climate control is activated. Optimum comfort can be
attained when the system is set to automatic
mode. Set the temperature to 22 †.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated or deactivated using the remote control
or the button on the centre console.
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected (Y page 229).
Operating the climate control system
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the centre console
button
General notes
139
The remote control has a maximum range of
approximately 300 metres. This range is
reduced by:
Rsources
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
Rsolid
i The optimum range can be achieved if you
i A battery symbol appears in the display
when the battery in the remote control is
low. Replace the remote control battery
(Y page 140).
The colours of the indicator lamps on the button have the following meanings:
Blue Auxiliary ventilation switched on
Red
Auxiliary heating switched on
Yellow Departure time preselected
(Y page 229)
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off
Switching on the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
lights up.
Switching off the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button :
goes out.
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the remote control
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For more information, please
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Remote control
: Display
; . To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
= ^ To switch off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
? u To switch on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
To activate: press the u button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Z
Climate control
hold the remote control vertically, pointing
upwards when you press one of the buttons.
140
Operating the climate control system
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the , or . button.
The following messages may appear in the
display:
Display
Meaning
Climate control
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
activated. The departure
time appears in the display.
Setting the departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or .
button, the faster the time changes.
X
Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The new departure time is stored.
Activating the set departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol and the departure time
appear in the display.
Deactivating a set departure time
Press the , or . button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Replacing the remote control battery
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
Operating the climate control system
141
H Environmental note
Climate control
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
One 6 V pin battery, type 2CR11108 is
required.
Prise apart the side arms of battery
cover ; and pull off battery cover ;.
X Remove old battery :.
X Insert the new battery. Observe the polarity
signs on the back of the remote control
when doing so.
X Slide battery cover ; back onto the
remote control.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
X
Z
142
Operating the climate control system
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
$
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle is
faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating on or off
using the remote control.
©
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
FAIL
Climate control
FAIL
The auxiliary heating is faulty.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
FAIL
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The auxiliary heating was started more than twice when the engine
was switched off.
X Switch on the engine and let it run for more than ten seconds.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The starter battery is not sufficiently charged.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
Adjusting the air vents
Display messages
143
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
Adjusting the air vents
Climate control
The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on or has switched itself
off.
The auxiliary heating is faulty.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Setting the centre air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves.
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles
in the vehicle interior.
To open the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : anticlockwise.
X To close the centre air vent: turn the
adjuster in one of centre air vents : clockwise as far as it will go.
X
i Move the adjusters for the air vents ver-
tically or horizontally, to set the direction of
the airflow.
i Optimal climate control function is ach-
ieved by opening the air vents fully and setting the adjusters to the middle position.
Z
Adjusting the air vents
144
Adjusting the side air vents
Climate control
: Side window demister vent
; Side air vent
To open a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in side air vent ; anti-clockwise.
X To close a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in side air vent ; clockwise as far as it will
go.
X
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
: Rear-compartment air vent, left
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
= Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = up or
down.
i If the control panel in the front is switched
off, no air can flow through the rear air
vents.
X
145
Useful information ............................ 146
Running-in notes ............................... 146
Manual transmission ........................ 154
Automatic transmission ................... 155
Refuelling ........................................... 163
Parking ............................................... 167
Driving tips ........................................ 170
Driving systems ................................ 173
Towing a trailer ................................. 207
Driving and parking
Driving ............................................... 146
146
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
In certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a certain distance is being driven after the vehicle
has been delivered or after repairs. Full system effectiveness is not reached until the end
of this teach-in procedure.
Brake pads/linings and discs that are either
new or have been replaced only achieve optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for the
reduced braking effect by applying greater
force to the brake pedal.
The first 1500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RDrive
at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red
area of the rev counter.
RDo
not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
RVehicles with automatic transmission:
try to avoid depressing the accelerator
pedal beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
After 1500 km, you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
Additional running-in notes for AMG vehicles:
RDo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1,500 km.
allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4,500 rpm briefly.
ROnly
i You should also observe these notes on
running-in if the engine or parts of the drive
train on your vehicle have been replaced.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
Rshoes with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Driving
Key positions
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
Rlose
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: avoid full-load operation
and engine speeds greater than 5000 rpm
when the engine is cold. This helps to protect the engine and avoids uncomfortable
driving.
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the engine
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
steering is locked when the key is taken out of
the ignition lock.
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle, it
can still be turned in the ignition lock. However, the ignition will not be switched on.
The engine cannot be started.
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
G WARNING
Flammable materials introduced through
environmental influence or by animals can
ignite if in contact with the exhaust system or
parts of the engine that heat up. There is a risk
of fire.
Z
Driving and parking
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
147
Driving
148
Driving and parking
Carry out regular checks to make sure that
there are no flammable foreign materials in
the engine compartment or in the exhaust
system.
! Do not depress the accelerator when
starting the engine.
i Vehicles with a petrol engine: the
engine runs at a higher engine speed during
the cold start procedure so that the catalytic converter can reach operating temperature more quickly. The sound of the
engine may change as a result.
i You can start the engine without preglow
if the engine is warm.
Pulling away
Manual transmission
! Change gear in good time and avoid spin-
ning the wheels. Otherwise, you could damage the vehicle.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Shift to neutral N.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully.
X Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
X Release the electric parking brake
(Y page 168).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Slowly release the clutch pedal and gently
depress the accelerator pedal.
i You can only start the engine when the
i Follow the shift recommendations in the
Automatic transmission
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
Manual transmission
X
clutch pedal is fully depressed.
X
Shift the transmission to position P.
Transmission position display P is shown in
the multifunction display.
i When the transmission is in position N,
you can also start the engine with the brake
pedal depressed.
Starting procedure
To start a petrol engine: turn the key to
position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 147)
and release it as soon as the engine is running.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 (Y page 147) in the ignition lock.
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X When the % preglow indicator lamp
goes out, turn the key to position
3 (Y page 147) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
X
X
multifunction display for an economical
driving style (Y page 155).
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 229).
Automatic transmission
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. Only then can
the parking lock be deactivated. If you do
not depress the brake pedal, the DIRECT
SELECT lever can still be moved but the
parking lock remains engaged.
i At transmission fluid temperatures below
Ò20 †, you can only shift out of position P
into another transmission position when
the engine is running.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
The electric parking brake is automatically
released (Y page 168).
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster remains lit.
X Depress the accelerator pedal.
X As soon as the vehicle/trailer combination
is held by the driving force of the engine,
release lever :.
the electric parking brake is released.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
i For further information on the electric
X
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 229).
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Pulling away with a trailer
parking brake, see (Y page 168).
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient. It
holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G WARNING
After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
The vehicle is then held for about a second.
X Pull away.
X
To ensure that you do not roll backwards
when pulling away on an uphill slope, engage
the electric parking brake.
X Press and hold handle :.
The electric parking brake continues to
brake and prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards.
Hill start assist is not active if:
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is in position N.
Rthe electric parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
Further information on holding the vehicle
stationary on uphill gradients (Y page 158).
Z
149
Driving and parking
Driving
150
Driving
ECO start/stop function
Driving and parking
Introduction
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is stopped under certain conditions.
When pulling away again, the engine starts
automatically. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
Automatic engine switch-off
General notes
The ECO start/stop function is operational
and the ¤ symbol is displayed in green in
the multifunction display, if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on
Rthe bonnet is closed
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off are fulfilled, the ¤ symbol is
shown in yellow.
i All of the vehicle's systems remain active
when the engine is switched off automatically.
i The engine can be switched off automat: ECO start/stop display
If the ¤ symbol is shown in green in the
multifunction display, the ECO start/stop
function switches the engine off automatically if the vehicle stops moving.
The stop/start function is automatically activated each time you start the engine with the
ignition key.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 151) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated,
the ¤ symbol is not displayed.
AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function
is only available in drive program C.
ically a maximum of four times (initial stop,
then three subsequent stops) in succession. The ¤ symbol is shown in yellow in
the multifunction display after the engine
has been started automatically for the
fourth time. When the ¤ symbol is
shown in green in the multifunction display,
automatic engine switch-off is again possible.
Vehicles with manual transmission
The ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically at low speeds.
Driving
151
Vehicles with manual transmission
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
Rdepress
Brake the vehicle.
Engage neutral N (Y page 155) (follow
gearshift instruction : to engage neutral
N, if necessary).
X Release the clutch pedal.
The engine is switched off automatically.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill in D or N,
the ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically.
i The HOLD function can be activated if the
engine has been switched off automatically. It is then not necessary to continue
applying the brakes during the automatic
stop phase. When you depress the accelerator pedal, the engine starts automatically and the braking effect of the HOLD
function is deactivated.
Rdepress
the clutch pedal fully
the accelerator pedal
Vehicles with automatic transmission
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rrelease
the brake pedal in transmission
position D or N when the HOLD function is
not active
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
Rmove the transmission out of position P
i Shifting the transmission to position P
does not start the engine.
i If you shift the transmission from R to D,
the ECO start/stop function is available
again once the ¤ symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
Deactivating/activating the ECO start/
stop function
Automatic engine start
General notes
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou
switch off the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button
Ryou engage reverse gear R
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the
driver's door
Rthe vehicle starts to roll
Rthe brake system requires this
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on
Rthe battery's charge status is too low
X
To deactivate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the ¤ symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
X
To activate: press ECO button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up.
If all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 150) are met, the ¤
symbol is lit green in the multifunction display.
Z
Driving and parking
The engine is started automatically if you:
Driving and parking
152
Driving
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 150) are met, the ¤
symbol is lit yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO start/stop
function is not available.
i If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/
stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The
engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
Driving
153
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 186) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 178).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Turn the key back to position 0 in the ignition lock before
attempting to start the engine again.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 147). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak or
discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 316).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
X
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Driving and parking
154
Manual transmission
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
the engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
coolant warning lamp
cool down.
may also be on and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 294). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Manual transmission
Gear lever
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal is
depressed.
trailer, you must shift into gear 1, 2 or 3 in
good time. This uses the engine's braking
effect. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly.
! When shifting to 5th and 6th gear, you
must press the shift lever to the right. Otherwise, you could shift unintentionally into
3rd or 4th gear and damage the engine or
transmission.
If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine
to overrev, leading to engine damage.
Do not use the clutch bite point to keep the
vehicle stationary on uphill gradients.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
clutch.
! On long and steep downhill gradients,
especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a
Gear lever
k
Reverse gear
1 to 6 Forward gears
Automatic transmission
Shifting to neutral N
155
Automatic transmission
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or R,
the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There is
a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
X
X
Depress the clutch pedal fully.
Move the gear lever to position N :.
Engaging reverse gear
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the
vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, you could
damage the transmission.
X
Pull the gear lever up, push it to the left and
then pull it back.
i The ECO start/stop function is not available when reverse gear is engaged.
For further information on the ECO start/
stop function; see (Y page 150).
Gearshift recommendation
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
i Bear in mind that power transmission
between the engine and the transmission is
interrupted when the engine is switched
off.
To prevent the vehicle from rolling away:
Rwhen
the engine is switched off and the
vehicle is stationary, shift the automatic
transmission to park position P and
Rapply the electric parking brake
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles): the
DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of the
steering column.
For information on the selector lever in AMG
vehicles (Y page 157).
X
Shift gear according to gearshift recommendation : when shown in the multifunction display of the instrument cluster.
Z
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
156
Automatic transmission
Engaging park position P
Driving and parking
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
Transmission position display P is shown in
the multifunction display.
i When you engage park position P, make
sure that the transmission position display
shows P in the multifunction display.
j
k
i
h
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
i The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns
to its original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears in the
transmission position display (Y page 156)
in the multifunction display.
Transmission position and drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
i The arrows in the transmission position
display show how and into which transmission positions you can change using the
DIRECT SELECT lever.
! If the transmission position display in the
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program E or
S.
i You can only engage park position P when
the vehicle is stationary.
i The automatic transmission shifts into
park position P automatically:
Rif
you open the driver's door while the
vehicle is stationary in transmission position D or R
Rif you open the door while travelling at
very low speeds in transmission position
D or R
In addition, a warning tone sounds and a
display message is shown.
i Depressing the brake and pushing the
DIRECT SELECT lever up or down disengages the parking lock. The transmission is
in N neutral.
At transmission fluid temperatures below
Ò20 †, you can only shift out of park position P into another transmission position
when the engine is running.
In order to shift from park position P
directly into R or D:
Rdepress
the brake pedal and
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or
down past the first point of resistance
Rpush
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
the automatic transmission directly from D
to R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise,
the automatic transmission could be damaged.
Automatic transmission
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to R
157
Transmission position and drive program display
i The ECO start/stop function is not available when reverse gear is engaged.
For further information on the ECO start/
stop function; see (Y page 150).
Depress the brake pedal while the vehicle is
stationary.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
Example
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
Shifting to neutral N
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
X
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
Engaging park position P
Engaging drive position D
Depress the brake pedal while the vehicle is
stationary.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
X
Selector lever
X
When the vehicle is stationary, press P button :.
Transmission positions
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
j Park position with parking lock
k Reverse gear
i Neutral
h Drive
B
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped. Do not
shift the transmission into position
P (Y page 167) unless the vehicle
is stationary.
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
when the vehicle is stationary.
158
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
A
7
Neutral
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of
skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
When you switch off the engine, the
automatic transmission automatically shifts into neutral N.
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
Driving tips
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined by:
Rthe
selected drive program (Y page 159)
position of the accelerator pedal
(Y page 158)
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
Rmore throttle: late upshifts
Holding the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients
G WARNING
If the clutch overheats, the electronic management system is automatically deactivated.
This interrupts the power transmission. The
vehicle may, for example, roll backwards on
gradients. There is a risk of an accident.
Never hold the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients by depressing the accelerator.
The clutch may overheat if you hold the vehicle stationary on uphill gradients by depressing the accelerator pedal. If the clutch overheats, a warning tone sounds.
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles): the
Stop vehicle Shift to P Leave engine
running display message appears in the multifunction display. You will only be able to
continue your journey once the clutch has
cooled down and the display message in the
multifunction display has disappeared.
AMG vehicles: the Trans. oil overhea‐
ted Drive on with care display message
appears in the multifunction display.
Never hold the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients by depressing the accelerator.
Instead, only ever hold the vehicle stationary
on uphill gradients by:
Rdepressing
the brake pedal
the HOLD function
Rengaging the electric parking brake
Ractivating
Kickdown
AMG vehicles: it is only possible to use kickdown in temporary manual drive program M.
For further information on manual drive program M (Y page 160).
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Automatic transmission
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RCLA
180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
RCLA 45 AMG 4MATIC
X Drive in the middle of the engine speed
range on uphill gradients.
X Depending on the uphill or downhill gradient, select a lower gear (Y page 171), even
if cruise control, DISTRONIC PLUS, or
SPEEDTRONIC are activated.
i For further information on the automatic
drive program, see (Y page 160).
AMG vehicles
Driving and parking
Towing a trailer
Program selector button
General notes
The program selector button allows you to
choose between drive programs with different driving characteristics.
C Controlled
Efficiency
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the multifunction display.
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program C each time the
engine is started.
i For further information on the automatic
Example: program selector button
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
X
159
drive program, see (Y page 160).
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the multifunction display.
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
Z
160
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
: Left steering wheel gearshift paddle
(shifts down)
; Right steering wheel gearshift paddle
(shifts up)
In drive program M, you can change gear
yourself using the steering wheel gearshift
paddles.
If you pull the left or right steering wheel gearshift paddle when in automatic drive program
E (drive program C on AMG vehicles) or S, the
automatic transmission shifts into drive program M for a limited time. Depending on
which gearshift paddle is pulled, the automatic transmission immediately shifts into
the next gear down or up.
AMG vehicles: you can activate drive program M RACE START (Y page 187) using the
steering wheel gearshift paddles.
i You can only change gear with the steer-
ing wheel gearshift paddles when the transmission is in position D.
i For further information on the manual
drive program, see (Y page 160).
Automatic drive program
Drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented
engine settings.
fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner.
Roptimal
Rthe
vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears unless the accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
Drive program S is characterised by the following:
Rsporty
engine settings.
automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher.
Rthe
Manual drive program
Introduction
In manual drive program M, you can change
gear yourself by using the steering wheel
gearshift paddles. For this, the transmission
must be in position D. The gear currently
selected and engaged is shown in the multifunction display.
Manual drive program M differs from drive
programs E (drive program C on AMG vehicles) and S with regard to spontaneity,
responsiveness and smoothness of gear
changes.
Gear
Driving situations
=
To use the engine's braking effect
Automatic transmission
To use the braking effect of the
engine on downhill gradients and
for driving:
steep mountain roads
mountainous terrain
Rin arduous conditions
Shifting up
X
Ron
Rin
4
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 160).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
i All vehicles (except AMG vehicles): in
order to prevent engine damage the automatic transmission automatically shifts up:
To use the braking effect of the
engine on extremely steep downhill
gradients and on long downhill
stretches
Rif the maximum engine speed on the cur-
rently engaged gear is reached and
depress the accelerator pedal.
Ryou
Activating the manual drive program
AMG vehicles:
Activating permanently
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
X
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
Press the program selector button
(Y page 159) repeatedly until M appears in
the multifunction display.
Manual drive program M remains active
until drive program E (drive program C on
AMG vehicles) or S is engaged.
Activating temporarily
X
Pull the right or left steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 160).
M is shown in the multifunction display.
Manual drive program M is temporarily
active. Depending on which gearshift paddle is pulled, the automatic transmission
immediately shifts into the next gear down
or up.
Gearshift recommendation
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
i When manual drive program M is activa-
ted via the steering wheel gearshift paddles, the temporarily active manual drive
program M will be deactivated automatically after a limited time, if the driving situation permits. The automatic transmission switches to the previously activated
drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) or S. When driving on downhill
gradients, the temporarily active manual
drive program M will only be deactivated if
the accelerator pedal is depressed while
the vehicle is rolling downhill.
X
Shift to recommended gear ; according
to gearshift recommendation : when
shown in the multifunction display of the
instrument cluster.
Z
Driving and parking
5
161
Automatic transmission
162
AMG vehicles
Kickdown
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
AMG vehicles: it is only possible to use kickdown in temporary manual drive program M.
Driving and parking
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
X
i During kickdown, you cannot shift gears
using the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
i If you apply full throttle, the automatic
transmission shifts up to the next gear
when the maximum engine speed is
reached. This prevents the engine from
overrevving.
: Gear indicator
; Upshift indicator
Before the engine speed reaches the red area,
an upshift indicator will be shown in the multifunction display.
X If the colour in the speedometer multifunction display changes to red and the UP display message is shown, shift up a gear.
Downshifting
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 160).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If you slow down or stop without shifting
down, the automatic transmission automatically shifts down.
i For maximum acceleration, pull the left-
hand steering wheel gearshift paddle until
the transmission selects the optimum gear
for the current speed.
i If the engine exceeds the maximum
engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine
damage by not shifting down.
Deactivating the manual drive program
X
Press the program selector button
(Y page 159) repeatedly until E (drive program C in AMG vehicles) or S appears in the
multifunction display.
Deactivating the temporary manual drive
program
X
Pull and hold the right steering wheel gearshift paddle until the automatic transmission shifts into the last active automatic
drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) or S.
i When manual drive program M is deacti-
vated, the automatic transmission in automatic drive program E (drive program C on
AMG vehicles) or S may shift from the current gear into a higher or lower gear. This is
dependent on the position of the accelerator pedal, speed and load.
Refuelling
163
Problems with the transmission
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
X Stop.
The transmission no
X Shift the transmission to position P.
longer shifts into all of
X Switch off the engine.
the gears.
X Wait at least 10seconds before restarting the engine.
Reverse gear can no
X Shift the transmission to position D.
longer be engaged.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf
fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
G WARNING
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapours. There is a risk of
fire and explosion.
Always touch the vehicle body before opening
the fuel filler flap or touching the fuel pump
nozzle. This discharges any electrostatic
charge that may have built up.
G WARNING
Vehicles with a diesel engine:
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Do not switch
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
Driving and parking
164
Refuelling
on the ignition if you accidentally refuel
with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will
enter the fuel system. Even small amounts
of the wrong fuel could result in damage to
the fuel system and the engine. The repair
costs are high. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
Opening the fuel filler flap
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refuelling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
If you overfill the fuel tank, some fuel may
spray out when you remove the fuel pump
nozzle.
Further information on fuel and fuel quality
(Y page 355).
Refuelling
:
;
=
?
Switch off the engine.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap swings up.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of fuel filler flap =.
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank, hook in place
and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
i Vehicles with a diesel engine: the filler
neck is designed for refuelling at diesel filling pumps.
X
X
i Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise,
fuel may leak out.
General notes
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle
with the key.
The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed
æ in the instrument cluster. The arrow
To open the fuel filler flap
Tyre pressure table
To insert the fuel filler cap
Fuel type to be refuelled
Closing the fuel filler flap
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
Refuelling
165
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
Driving and parking
vehicle.
Z
166
Refuelling
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Fuel is leaking from the The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
vehicle.
G WARNING
There is a risk of fire or explosion.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock immediately and
remove it (Y page 147).
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
start.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least 5 litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for approximately ten seconds
(Y page 147).
X Start the engine continuously for a maximum of ten seconds
until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again a maximum of ten seconds
(Y page 147).
X Start the engine again continuously for a maximum of ten seconds until it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
or
The key battery is discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 79).
or
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 79).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact with
hot parts of the exhaust system or exhaust
gas flow. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable material can come into contact with hot vehicle
components. In particular, do not park on dry
grassland or harvested grain fields.
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
! Always secure the vehicle correctly
against rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle
or its drivetrain could be damaged.
key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron uphill or downhill gradients, the front
wheels must be turned towards the kerb.
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The automatic transmission switches to neutral position N when you switch off the engine.
The vehicle may roll away. There is a risk of an
accident.
After switching off the engine, always switch
to parking position P. Prevent the parked vehicle from rolling away by applying the parking
brake.
Vehicles with manual transmission
Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles)
X
X
Apply the electric parking brake.
Shift the transmission to position P.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe electric parking brake must be applied.
Ron
vehicles with manual transmission,
engage first gear or reverse gear.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission must be in position P and
the transmission position display must
show P in the multifunction display.
Z
Driving and parking
Rthe
Parking
Rrelease
167
Parking
168
AMG vehicles:
X
Driving and parking
X
X
Apply the electric parking brake.
Press button :.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
i If you switch the engine off with the trans-
mission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
If you then open one of the front doors or
remove the key from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
If you shift the automatic transmission to N
before switching off the engine, the automatic transmission remains in N even if a
door is opened.
The function of the electric parking brake is
dependent on the on-board voltage. If the onboard voltage is low or if there is a malfunction in the system, it may not be possible to
apply the released parking brake.
If this is the case, only park the vehicle on
level ground and secure it to prevent it from
rolling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first gear.
X
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake if the on-board voltage is low or
if there is a malfunction in the system. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
i The electric parking brake carries out a
Electric parking brake
General notes
function check at regular intervals when
the engine is switched off. Noises that
occur are normal.
G WARNING
If you leave children unattended in the vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake
Rshift the automatic transmission out of park
position P or shift manual transmission into
neutral
Rstart the engine
In addition, they may operate vehicle equipment and become trapped. There is a risk of
an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unattended in the vehicle.
Engaging/releasing manually
Engaging
X Push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the ! red indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
i The electric parking brake can also be
applied when the key is removed.
Parking
i You can only release the electric parking
brake when the key is in position 1 or 2 in
the ignition lock.
Applying automatically
The electric parking brake is applied automatically:
Rif
DISTRONIC PLUS brings the vehicle to a
standstill (vehicles with automatic transmission) or
Rif the HOLD function is keeping the vehicle
stationary or
Rif Active Parking Assist is holding the vehicle at a standstill
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
engine is switched off
Rthe driver's door is open and the seat belt is
Rthe
seat belt is fastened.
depress the accelerator pedal.
If the transmission is in position R, the boot lid
must be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled to automatically
release the electric parking brake:
Ryou
Rthe
driver's door is closed.
have shifted out of transmission position P or you have previously driven faster
than 3 km/h.
Ryou
i Ensure that you do not depress the accel-
erator pedal unintentionally. Otherwise the
parking brake will be released and the vehicle will start to move.
Emergency braking
The vehicle can also be braked during an
emergency by using the electric parking
brake.
X While driving, push handle : of the electric
parking brake (Y page 168).
not fastened
is a system malfunction
Rthe power supply is insufficient
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
i The vehicle is braked as long as you keep
i The electric parking brake is not automat-
Ra
Rthere
ically applied if the engine is switched off by
the ECO start/stop function.
Releasing automatically
i The electric parking brake can only be
released automatically in vehicles with
automatic transmission.
The electric parking brake of your vehicle is
released automatically when all of the following conditions are fulfilled:
Rthe
Rthe
engine is running.
transmission is in position D or R.
handle : of the electric parking brake
pressed. The longer the electric parking
brake handle : is depressed, the greater
the braking force.
During braking:
warning tone sounds
Release parking brake message
appears
Rthe red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is applied.
Rthe
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharging.
Z
Driving and parking
Releasing
X Pull handle :.
The red ! indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
169
Driving tips
170
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use.
Driving and parking
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving tips
General notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
ECO display
The ECO display provides feedback on how
economical your driving characteristics are.
The ECO display assists you in achieving the
most economical driving style for the selected settings and prevailing conditions. Consumption can be significantly influenced by
your driving style.
Example: ECO display
The ECO display consists of three bars:
RAcceleration
RConstant
RCoasting
The percentage count is the mean value of the
three bar values. The three bars and the mean
value begin at the value of 50 %. A higher percentage count indicates a more economical
driving style.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual
fuel consumption. A fixed percentage count
in the ECO display does not indicate a fixed
consumption.
In addition to driving style, the consumption is
affected by many other factors, such as:
Rload
Rtyre
pressure
start
Rchoice of route
Rthe use of electrical consumers
These factors are not included in the ECO display.
The evaluation of your driving style takes the
following three categories into consideration:
RAcceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes):
- The bar fills up: moderate acceleration,
especially at higher speeds
- The bar empties: sporty acceleration
RConstant (assessment of driving behaviour at all times):
- The bar fills up: constant speed and
avoidance of unnecessary acceleration
and deceleration
- The bar empties: fluctuations in speed
RCoasting (assessment of all deceleration
processes):
- The bar fills up: anticipatory driving,
keeping your distance and early release
of the accelerator. The vehicle can coast
without use of the brakes
- The bar empties: frequent braking
Rcold
i An economical driving style involves driv-
ing at a moderate engine speed.
To achieve a higher value in the categories
Acceleration and Constant
Constant:
Driving tips
the gearshift recommendation.
Rdrive the vehicle in drive program E (vehi-
cles with automatic transmission).
i On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g.
on the motorway, only the bar for Constant
will change.
i The ECO display summarises the driving
characteristics from the start of the journey
to its completion. Therefore, there are
dynamic changes in the bars at the start of
a journey. During a prolonged driving time,
these changes are smaller. For more
dynamic changes, perform a manual reset.
For further information on the ECO display,
see (Y page 218).
Braking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle and
when towing a trailer. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to have selected manual drive program M (Y page 160).
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
i Briefly depressing the accelerator pedal
on downhill gradients while the manual
drive program M is temporarily activated
(vehicles with automatic transmission): the
automatic transmission may switch back to
the last active automatic drive program E or
S. The automatic transmission may shift to
a higher gear. This can reduce the engine's
braking effect.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If heavy demands are made on the brakes, do
not park the vehicle immediately. Drive on for
a short while. This allows the airflow to cool
the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed, paying attention to traffic conditions. This improves the grip of the brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after a car wash or
after driving through deep water.
You have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance from the
vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attenZ
Driving and parking
Robserve
171
172
Driving tips
Driving and parking
tion to the traffic conditions. This will warm up
the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salted roads, a layer of salt
residue may form on the brake discs and
brake pads. This can result in a significantly
longer braking distance.
RBrake occasionally to remove any possible
salt residue. Make sure that you do not
endanger other road users when doing so.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal and the
beginning and end of a journey.
RMaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead.
New brake pads/linings
New and replaced brake pads and discs only
reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the
brake pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
Driving on wet roads
For this reason, drive in the following manner
in the event of heavy rain or in conditions in
which aquaplaning can occur:
Rlower
your speed
tyre ruts
Ravoid sudden steering movements
Rbrake carefully
Ravoid
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe
maximum permissible fording depth in
still water is 25 cm
Ryou should drive no faster than walking
pace
Winter driving
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Aquaplaning
G DANGER
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
Ryou
Rthe
are driving at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
Driving systems
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres. Do
not use cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
X
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
For more information on driving with snow
chains, see (Y page 329).
For more information on driving with summer
tyres, see (Y page 328).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 328).
Driving systems
Cruise control
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. You must
select a lower gear in good time on long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected manual drive program M
(Y page 160). By doing so, you will make use
of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions are appropriate for maintaining a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise
control can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override the laws of physics. Cruise
control cannot take into account road,
weather or traffic conditions. Cruise control is
only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed,
for braking in good time, and for staying in the
lane.
Do not use cruise control:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed
(e.g. in heavy traffic or on winding roads).
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid.
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Z
Driving and parking
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open a
window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
173
174
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Cruise control lever
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Ron
vehicles with manual transmission, a
gear must be engaged.
Rcruise control must be selected.
X To select cruise control: check whether
LIM indicator lamp ; is on or off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
X If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Storing, maintaining and calling up a
speed
: To activate or increase speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
? To activate or reduce speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds.
Activation conditions
To activate cruise control, all of the following
activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
electric parking brake must be
released.
Ryou are driving faster than 30 km/h.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the selector lever must be in position D.
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically braking the vehicle.
i Vehicles with manual transmission:
Ralways
drive at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds
Rchange gear in good time
Rif possible, do not change down several
gears at a time
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
Driving systems
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Setting a speed
Keep in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
X Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ? to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
briefly up : or down ? beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B .
or
X
Brake.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Rthe
vehicle is secured with the electric
parking brake
Ryou are driving at less than 30 km/h
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rwhile driving a vehicle with manual transmission, you shift into neutral or depress
the clutch pedal for longer than six seconds
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you
shift to a gear that is too high, and as a
result the engine speed is too low
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
you shift into position N while driving
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise con‐
trol off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. You must
select a lower gear in good time on long and
Z
Driving and parking
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
175
Driving and parking
176
Driving systems
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer. For vehicles with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected manual drive program M
(Y page 160). By doing so, you will make use
of the braking effect of the engine. This
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly. If you need additional
braking, depress the brake pedal repeatedly
rather than continuously.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 177)
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
When the engine is running, you can use the
cruise control lever to limit the speed to any
speed between 30 km/h and the technically
permitted maximum speed of the vehicle. If
the set value of permanent SPEEDTRONIC is
lower then this value applies (Y page 177).
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, SPEEDTRONIC can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics.
SPEEDTRONIC cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid. You are responsible for
the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle
speed, for braking in good time, and for staying in lane.
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
A To switch between cruise control or DIS-
TRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
selected.
X
Driving systems
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ?.
The current speed is stored. The multifunction display shows the stored speed, such
as SPEEDTRONIC Limit 100 km/h
km/h, for five
seconds.
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it is lower
than the current speed, the vehicle decelerates. If you do not know the stored speed, the
vehicle could decelerate unexpectedly. There
is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed, or down ? for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ? for a lower
speed.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : past the pressure point for
a higher speed, or down ? for a lower
speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
X
up : for a higher speed or down ? for a
lower speed.
Switching SPEEDTRONIC to passive
If you depress the accelerator pedal beyond
the pressure point (kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC is switched to passive mode. The following message appears in the multifunction
display: SPEEDTRONIC passive.
passive
You can then exceed the stored speed.
SPEEDTRONIC is activated again if you:
Rdrive slower than the stored speed without
kickdown
Rset a new speed or
Rcall up the last speed stored again
The SPEEDTRONIC passive message in the
multifunction display disappears.
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
SPEEDTRONIC switches off if you shift to a
higher gear and as a result, the engine speed
is too low.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
Z
Driving and parking
Storing the current speed
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
177
Driving and parking
178
Driving systems
160 km/h(e.g. for driving on winter tyres) and
the maximum speed (Y page 228).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. Vehicles are detected with the aid of the radar
sensor system. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes
automatically so that the set speed is not
exceeded.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on
the brake system and prevents the brakes
from overheating and wearing too quickly.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that there is a risk
of a collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically. Without your intervention, DISTRONIC PLUS cannot prevent a collision. An
intermittent warning tone will then sound and
the distance warning lamp will light up in the
instrument cluster. Brake immediately to
increase the distance to the vehicle driving in
front, or take evasive action, provided it is
safe to do so.
DISTRONIC PLUS operates in the range
between 0 km/h and 200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react to:
Rpeople
or animals
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
As a result, DISTRONIC PLUS may neither give
warnings nor intervene in such situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Roncoming
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot always clearly identify other road users and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, DISTRONIC PLUS may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
Raccelerate unexpectedly
There is a risk of an accident.
Continue to drive carefully and be ready to
brake, in particular when warned to do so by
DISTRONIC PLUS.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle with up
to 50% of the maximum possible deceleration.
If this deceleration is not sufficient, DISTRONIC PLUS alerts you with a visual and
acoustic warning. There is a risk of an accident.
Apply the brakes yourself in these situations
and try to take evasive action.
Driving systems
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
If you fail to adapt your driving style, DISTRONIC PLUS can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take road and
weather conditions or traffic conditions into
account. DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid. You
are responsible for the distance to the vehicle
in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in the lane.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed
(e.g. in heavy traffic or on winding roads)
Ron smooth or slippery roads. Braking or
accelerating can cause the drive wheels to
lose traction and the vehicle could then
skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow
vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or
vehicles driving on a different line.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
If DISTRONIC PLUS no longer detects a vehicle in front, it may unexpectedly accelerate to
the speed stored.
This speed can:
Rbe
too high for a filter lane or a slip road
so high in the right lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the left
Rbe so high in the left lane that you pass
vehicles driving on the right
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Rbe
Cruise control lever
You can operate DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control
lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: DISTRONIC PLUS
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp = is off.
Z
Driving and parking
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
179
Driving and parking
180
Driving systems
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
X If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow B.
LIM indicator lamp = in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Activating DISTRONIC PLUS
Activation conditions
To activate DISTRONIC PLUS, all of the following activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
to two minutes of driving before DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Rthe electric parking brake must be
released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
RActive Parking Assist must not be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door and the rear
doors must be closed.
Rthe DISTRONIC PLUS function must be
selected with the cruise control lever
(Y page 179).
Activating
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ? or press it up : or down A.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed up :
or down A until the desired speed is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS inactive
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
You can also activate DISTRONIC PLUS when
stationary. The lowest speed that can be set is
30 km/h.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ? or press it up : or down A.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
Activating at the current speed/last
stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up a stored speed and this is different from the current speed, the vehicle
accelerates or brakes. If you do not know
what the stored speed is, the vehicle may
accelerate or brake unexpectedly. There is a
risk of an accident.
Take the traffic conditions into account
before calling up the stored speed. If you do
not know what the stored speed is, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever
(Y page 179) towards you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
Driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
Pulling away and driving
i The vehicle can also pull away when it is
facing an unidentified obstacle or is driving
on a different line from another vehicle. The
vehicle then brakes automatically. There is
a risk of an accident. Be ready to brake at all
times.
DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated when you
depress the brake, except when the vehicle is
stationary.
X If you want to pull away with DISTRONIC PLUS: remove your foot from the
brake pedal.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever
(Y page 179) towards you ?.
or
X Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
If no vehicle is detected in front, your vehicle accelerates to the set speed.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle.
In this way, the distance you have selected is
maintained.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed.
The vehicle is only accelerated up to the
speed you have stored.
Selecting the drive program
DISTRONIC Plus supports a sporty driving
style when you have selected the S or M driving program (Y page 159). Acceleration
behind the vehicle in front or to the set speed
is then noticeably more dynamic. If you have
selected the E driving program, the vehicle
accelerates more gently. This setting is recommended in stop-and-start traffic.
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
i When you change lanes, DISTRONIC
PLUS monitors the left lane (on left-handdrive vehicles) or the right lane (on righthand-drive vehicles).
Stopping
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, even if it is braked
only by DISTRONIC PLUS, it could roll away if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
RDISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated
with the cruise control lever, e.g. by a vehicle occupant or from outside the vehicle.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have
been tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
Rthe accelerator pedal has been depressed,
e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
There is a risk of an accident.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
Changing lanes
If you change to the overtaking lane, DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
For further information on deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 183).
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle in
front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until it
is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
Ryou
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
are driving faster than 70 km/h
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front
Ryou switch on the respective turn signal
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision
RDISTRONIC
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill
at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle in
Z
181
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
182
Driving and parking
front. The specified minimum distance is
set using the control on the cruise control
lever.
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
and:
Rthe seat belt is unfastened and the driver's
door is open
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is auto-
matically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is not sufficient
If a malfunction occurs, then the transmission
may also be shifted into position P automatically.
Setting a speed
Bear in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the set speed.
To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
briefly up : or down ; beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
X
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS
adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS keeps to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 184).
i Make sure that you maintain the mini-
mum distance to the vehicle in front as
required by law. Adjust the distance to the
vehicle in front if necessary.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To store the current speed or a lower
speed
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X
Driving systems
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou apply the electric parking brake or if the
vehicle is automatically secured with the
electric parking brake
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontpassenger door or one of the rear doors is
open
Rthe vehicle is skidding
Ryou activate Active Parking Assist
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. You will see the DIS‐
TRONIC PLUS off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the instrument cluster
Displays in the speedometer
There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you
will see the DISTRONIC PLUS off message in
the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine. DISTRONIC PLUS
is not deactivated if you depress the accelerator pedal.
Example: DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the speedometer
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or
two segments ; in the set speed range light
up.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front = and stored speed : light up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
Z
Driving and parking
To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
183
184
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
X
Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 223).
You will initially see the stored speed for
about five seconds when you activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Distance indicator: current distance to
the vehicle in front
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
General notes
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must
be particularly attentive. In such situations,
brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then
deactivated.
Cornering, going into and coming out of a
bend
? Own vehicle
In the Assistance menu (Y page 223) of the
on-board computer, you can select the assistance graphic.
X Select the Assistance graphic function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 223).
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Vehicles which are not driving in the middle of their lane
: Vehicle in front, if detected
; Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
= Own vehicle
? DISTRONIC PLUS active (text only
appears when the cruise control lever is
actuated)
Driving systems
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
Other vehicles changing lane
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Crossing vehicles
Narrow vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.
DISTRONIC PLUS may detect vehicles that
are crossing your lane by mistake. Activating
DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with crossing traffic, for example, could cause your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
Z
Driving and parking
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
which are not driving in the middle of their
lane. The distance to the vehicle in front will
be too short.
185
186
Driving systems
HOLD function
Important safety notes
Driving and parking
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply
Rthe HOLD function is deactivated by the
accelerator pedal being depressed, e.g. by
a vehicle occupant
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
Before leaving the vehicle, always deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
from rolling away.
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary
engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Rthe driver's door is closed or if your seat
belt is fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N on
vehicles with automatic transmission
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
Rthe
Activating the HOLD function
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 186).
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Example: vehicles with colour multifunction display
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou accelerate. On vehicles with automatic
transmission: only when the transmission
is in position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P on vehicles
with automatic transmission.
Driving systems
depress the brake pedal again with a
certain amount of pressure until : disappears from the multifunction display.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric
parking brake.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
i After a short period, the vehicle is secured
by the electric parking brake, thus relieving
the service brake.
RACE START
Important safety notes
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. The precondition for
this is a suitable high-grip road surface.
Only activate RACE START on dedicated race
circuits.
i RACE START is only available in AMG vehicles.
The electric parking brake secures the vehicle
automatically if the HOLD function is activated and:
Activation conditions
Rthe
You can activate RACE START if:
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function
Ra system fault occurs
Rthe power supply is not sufficient
Vehicles with automatic transmission
If a malfunction occurs, then the transmission
may also be shifted into position P automatically.
Vehicles with manual transmission
The Brake immediately message can also
appear in the multifunction display.
X Immediately depress the brake pedal firmly
until the warning message in the multifunction display goes out.
The HOLD function is deactivated.
A horn will sound at regular intervals if you
turn off the engine, take off your seat belt or
open the driver's door when the HOLD function is activated. The horn alerts you to the
fact that the HOLD function is still activated.
If you attempt to lock the vehicle, the tone
becomes louder. The vehicle cannot be
locked until you have deactivated the HOLD
function.
i Once you have switched off the engine,
you cannot restart it until you have deactivated the HOLD function.
Rthe
doors, the bonnet and the boot lid are
closed
Rthe engine is running and the transmission,
traction control and engine are at operating
temperature
RSPORT handling mode is activated
(Y page 70)
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position.
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot)
Rthe transmission is in position D
Rdrive program M is selected (Y page 159).
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Pull and hold both steering wheel gearshift
paddles.
X The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears
in the multifunction display.
X Release both steering wheel gearshift paddles.
i If the activation conditions are no longer
fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The
RACE START not possible See Own‐
er's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Z
Driving and parking
Ryou
187
Driving systems
188
X
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 160).
or
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 160).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal within a few seconds, RACE START is
cancelled. The multifunction display shows
the RACE START cancelled message.
Driving and parking
X
Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed is increased.
The RACE START Release brake to
start message appears in the multifunction display.
i If the brake pedal is not released after a
short while, RACE START is cancelled. The
multifunction display shows the RACE
START cancelled message.
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active message appears
in the multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
Drive program S is activated. SPORT handling
mode remains activated.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The RACE START
not possible or RACE START cancelled
message appears in the multifunction display.
i After using it several times in short succession, RACE START will be unavailable
until a certain distance has been driven.
4MATIC
4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are permanently driven. Together with ESP®, it
improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel spins due to insufficient
grip.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, 4MATIC
can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor
override the laws of physics. 4MATIC cannot
take account of road, weather and traffic conditions. 4MATIC is only an aid. You are
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good
time, and for staying in lane.
If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip:
Rwhen
pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
Raccelerate less when driving.
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle
raised. This may damage the transfer case.
Damage of this sort is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty. All
wheels must remain either on the ground or
be fully raised. Observe the instructions for
towing the vehicle with all wheels in full
contact with the ground.
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if
you use winter tyres (M+S tyres), with snow
chains if necessary.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It monitors the area
around your vehicle using six sensors in the
front bumper and six sensors in the rear
bumper. PARKTRONIC indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a substitute for your attention to the immediate surroundings. The responsibility for safe
Driving systems
189
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically if
you:
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
Side view
Rswitch
on the ignition
to position D, R or N on vehicles with
automatic transmission
Rrelease the electric parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
Rshift
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take into account
obstacles located:
Rbelow
the detection range, e.g. persons,
animals or objects
Rabove the detection range, e.g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of
goods vehicles
Top view
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 300).
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Z
Driving and parking
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
190
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Rear sensors
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 20 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
The gear lever position or the transmission
position of the automatic transmission and
the direction in which the vehicle is rolling
determine which warning display is active
when the engine is running.
Manual transmission:
Gear lever position
Warning display
Forward gear
or
Neutral
Front area activated
Reverse gear or
Rear and front areas
the vehicle is rolling activated
backwards
Automatic transmission:
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Driving systems
191
Driving and parking
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Indicator lamp
; Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Towing a trailer
! Fold in the ball coupling if the trailer tow
hitch is not required. PARKTRONIC measures the minimum detection range to an
obstacle from the bumper, not the ball coupling.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
Z
192
Driving systems
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has been deactivated.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated and the
indicator lamp on the
PARKTRONIC button
lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 300).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is then
deactivated.
The problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. It measures the road on
both sides of the vehicle. A parking symbol
indicates a suitable parking space. Active
steering intervention can assist you during
manoeuvring and parking. You may also use
PARKTRONIC (Y page 188).
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that no persons, animals or
objects are in the manoeuvring range.
When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active
Parking Assist is also unavailable.
G WARNING
While parking or pulling out of a parking
space, the vehicle swings out and can drive
onto areas of the oncoming lane. This could
cause you to collide with other road users.
There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to other road users. Stop the
vehicle if necessary or cancel the Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at a
sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Active Parking Assist may also display spaces
not suitable for parking, e.g.:
Rparking
or stopping prohibitions
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Runsuitable
surfaces
Parking tips:
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
Rparking spaces that are littered or overgrown might be identified or measured
incorrectly.
Rparking spaces that are partially occupied
by trailer drawbars might not be identified
as such or be measured incorrectly.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 190) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Ryou can intervene in the steering procedure
to correct it at any time. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are fitted.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces
that are:
Rparallel or at right angles to the direction of
travel
straight roads, not bends
Ron the same level as the road, e.g. not on
the pavement
Ron
G WARNING
If objects are located above the detection
range, Active Parking Assist may start to steer
into the parking space too soon. As a result,
you could cause a collision. There is a risk of
an accident.
If objects are located above the detection
range, stop the vehicle and switch Active
Parking Assist off.
For further information on the detection
range (Y page 189).
Active Parking Assist does not support you
parking in spaces at right angles to the direction of travel if:
Rtwo
parking spaces are located directly
next to one another
Rthe parking space is directly next to a low
obstacle such as a low kerb stone
Ryou forward park
Active Parking Assist does not support you
parking in spaces that are parallel or at right
angles to the direction of travel if:
Rthe
parking space is on a kerb stone
parking space appears to be blocked,
for example by foliage or grass paving
blocks
Rthe range of movement is too small
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle which is not clearly defined such as a
tree or a trailer
Rthe
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles.
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is activated automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
Z
193
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
194
Driving systems
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rthat
are parallel or at right angles to the
direction of travel
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel
and are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are parallel to the direction of travel
and at least 1.0 m longer than your vehicle
Rthat are at right angles to the direction of
travel and at least 1.0 m wider than your
vehicle
i In the case of parking spaces that are at
right angles to the direction of travel,
please ensure that the parking space is
long enough to accommodate your vehicle.
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
will see parking symbol ; as a status indicator in the instrument cluster. When a parking space has been detected, an arrow
towards the right or the left also appears.
Active Parking Assist only displays parking
spaces on the front-passenger side as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's side are
displayed as soon as the turn signal on the
driver's side is activated. When parking on the
driver's side, this must remain switched on
until you acknowledge the use of Active Parking Assist by pressing the a button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
The system automatically determines
whether the parking space is parallel or at
right angles to the direction of travel.
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Parking
G WARNING
Active Parking Assist merely aids you by intervening actively in the steering. There is a risk
of accident if you do not apply the brakes
yourself.
Always apply the brakes yourself when parking and manoeuvring.
Stop the vehicle when the parking symbol
shows the desired parking space in the
instrument cluster.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: shift to
reverse gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift
into position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. Do not exceed a maximum speed
of approximately 10 km/h when reversing.
Otherwise, Active Parking Assist will be
cancelled.
i In tight parking spaces, you will achieve
the best parking results by backing up as
far as possible. When doing so, also
observe the PARKTRONIC messages.
X
X
X
Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Park Assist active Engage forward
gear Observe surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Park Assist active Select D Observe
Driving systems
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
Park Assist active Engage reverse
gear Observe surroundings message
appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
Park Assist active Select R Observe
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
Additional transmission shifts may be necessary.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears and a warning tone sounds.
Active Parking Assist is then deactivated.
PARKTRONIC is still available.
Active Parking Assist no longer supports you
with steering interventions. When Active
Parking Assist is finished, you must steer
again yourself. PARKTRONIC is still available.
X Manoeuvre if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 190).
Parking tips:
RThe
way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. It may be the case that Active
Parking Assist guides you too far into a
parking space, or not far enough into it. In
some cases, it may also lead you across or
onto the kerb. If necessary, you should cancel the parking procedure with Active Parking Assist.
RYou can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should a
gear be changed too early, the parking procedure will be cancelled. A sensible parking
position can no longer be achieved from
this position.
Exiting a parking space
In order that Active Parking Assist can support you when you exit the parking space:
Rthe
border of the parking space must be
high enough. A kerb stone is too small, for
example.
Rthe border of the parking space must not be
too wide, as the position of the vehicle must
not exceed an angle of 45° to the starting
position as it is manoeuvred into the parking space.
Ra manoeuvring distance of at least 1.0 m
must be available.
Active Parking Assist can only assist you with
exiting a parking space if you have parked the
vehicle parallel to the direction of travel using
Active Parking Assist.
X Start the engine.
X Switch on the turn signal in the direction
you are pulling away.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first or reverse gear.
Z
Driving and parking
surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to first gear while the vehicle is stationary.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
select transmission position D while the
vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
195
Driving and parking
196
Driving systems
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position D or R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To exit a parking space using Active
Parking Assist: press the a button on
the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Release the multifunction steering wheel.
X Reverse the vehicle or drive forwards, being
ready to brake at all times. Do not exceed a
maximum speed of approximately 10 km/h
when exiting a parking space. Otherwise,
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled.
X Stop when PARKTRONIC sounds the continuous warning tone, if not before.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first gear or reverse gear when the
vehicle is stationary, depending on the
message or requirement.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position D or R
when the vehicle is stationary, depending
on the message or requirement.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction. The Park Assist
active Accelerate and brake
Observe surroundings message appears
in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
If you reverse after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
Drive forwards and reverse as prompted by
the PARKTRONIC warning displays, several
times if necessary.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and
the Park Assist switched off message
appears in the multifunction display. You will
then have to steer and merge into traffic on
your own. PARKTRONIC is still available. You
can take over the steering before the vehicle
has exited the parking space completely. This
is useful, for example when you recognise
that it is already possible to pull out of the
parking space.
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
X
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button on the
centre console (Y page 191).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rthe
electric parking brake is applied
position P is selected
Rparking using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
The ÷ warning lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
Rtransmission
Driving systems
Towing a trailer
For vehicles with a trailer tow hitch, the minimum required length for parking spaces is
slightly increased.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle,
you should not use Active Parking Assist.
Once the electrical connection is established
between your vehicle and the trailer, Active
Parking Assist is no longer available. PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area.
Reversing camera
General notes
technical reasons, the flap may remain open
briefly after the reversing camera has been
deactivated. If you switch off the engine, the
flap will also close.
i The text of messages shown in the
COMAND display depends on the language
setting. The following are examples of
reversing camera messages in the
COMAND display.
Observe the notes on cleaning (Y page 300).
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the immediate
surroundings. The responsibility for safe
manoeuvring and parking remains with you.
Make sure that there are no persons, animals
or objects in range while manoeuvring and
parking.
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Rif
Reversing camera : is in the boot lid handle.
The reversing camera is an optical parking
and manoeuvring aid. It uses guide lines to
show the area behind your vehicle in the
Audio/COMAND display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
The reversing camera is protected from raindrops and dust by means of a flap. When the
reversing camera is activated, this flap opens.
Only once the manoeuvring process has been
completed and the reversing camera has
switched off does the flap close again. For
the boot lid is open
Rin heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent light or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the
reversing camera may be restricted due to
additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g. licence plate holder, bicycle rack).
Z
Driving and parking
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
disappears and the multifunction display
shows the Park Assist cancelled message.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
197
Driving systems
198
Activating/deactivating the reversing
camera
To activate: make sure that the key is in
position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "Activation by R gear"
function is selected in the Audio system/
COMAND Online; see the separate operating instructions.
X Engage reverse gear.
Guide lines are used to show the area
behind the vehicle in the Audio/COMAND
display.
Driving and parking
X
Displays in the Audio/COMAND display
The reversing camera may show a distorted
view of obstacles or show them incorrectly or
not at all. Obstacles are not shown by the
reversing camera in the following locations:
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
the rear bumper
Rin close range above the handle on the boot
lid
Runder
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
Rthe drawbar of a trailer
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Function mode display for vehicles with COMAND
Online and a trailer tow hitch
X
To change the function mode in vehicles with COMAND Online and trailer
tow hitch: using the COMAND controller,
select symbol : for the "Reverse parking"
function; see the separate COMAND Online
operating instructions.
or
X
Select symbol ; for the "Coupling up a
trailer" function (see the separate
COMAND Online operating instructions).
The symbol of the selected function is highlighted.
To deactivate: the reversing camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P on
vehicles with automatic transmission or after
driving forwards a short distance.
Lanes
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; Yellow lane marking the course the tyres
will take at the current steering wheel
angle, vehicle width including the outer
edge of the wheel (dynamic)
= Red guide line for the vehicle width including the exterior mirrors, for current steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Bumper
Driving systems
199
"Reverse parking" function
X
Guide lines
? Bumper
A Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.25 m from the rear of the vehicle
Make sure that the reversing camera is
activated and the "Reverse parking" function is selected; see the separate operating
instructions for the audio system/
COMAND Online.
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
Reversing straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
B Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 4.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
C Vehicle centre axis (marker assistance)
D Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
The lanes and guide lines are only displayed if
you have engaged reverse gear.
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
: White lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel straight
; Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 1.0 m from the rear of the vehicle
= Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.25 m from the rear of the vehicle
With the help of white lane :, check
whether the vehicle will fit into the parking
space.
X Using the white lane as a guide, carefully
reverse until you reach the end position.
Red guide line = is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel in the parking space.
X
Additional displays on vehicles with PARKTRONIC
and COMAND Online
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC and COMAND
Online: when PARKTRONIC is operational
(Y page 188), additional operational readiness indicator ; appears in the COMAND
display. If the PARKTRONIC warning displays
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
X Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
Z
Driving and parking
are active or light up, warning displays : and
= are also active or light up correspondingly
in the COMAND display.
Driving systems
Driving and parking
200
Turning the steering wheel
: Red lane indicating the route the vehicle
Driving to the final position
: White lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel in its current position
; Parking space marking
will take with the steering wheel in its current position
; Parking space marking
While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parking space until the red lane reaches parking
space marking ;.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position
and reverse carefully.
X
X
Turn the steering wheel to the centre position while the vehicle is stationary.
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.25 m from the rear of the vehicle
; White lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel straight
Reversing with the steering wheel turned
: Red lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel in its current position
X
Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
= End of parking space
X
Reverse carefully until you have reached
the end position.
Red guide line : is then at end of parking
space =. The vehicle is almost parallel in
the parking space.
"Coupling up a trailer" function
This function is only available on vehicles with
a trailer tow hitch and COMAND Online.
apply to objects that are at the same level
as the ball coupling.
X Reverse carefully, making sure that trailer
drawbar locating aid = points approximately in the direction of trailer drawbar ?.
X Reverse carefully until trailer drawbar ?
touches red guide line ;.
X Couple up the trailer (Y page 207).
: Vehicle centre point on the yellow guide
line at a distance of approximately 1.0 m
from the rear of the vehicle
; Trailer drawbar
= Ball coupling
X Set the height of trailer drawbar ; so that
it is slightly higher than ball coupling =.
X Position the vehicle centrally in front of
trailer drawbar ;.
ATTENTION ASSIST
General notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 80 km/h to
180 km/h range.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
Important safety notes
: Ball coupling
; Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 0.25 m from the ball coupling
= Trailer drawbar locating aid
? Trailer drawbar
A Symbol for the "Coupling up a trailer"
function
X
Select symbol A with the Audio/COMAND
controller; see the separate operating
instructions for the audio system/
COMAND Online.
The "Coupling up a trailer" function is selected. The distance specifications now only
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It may not
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration until too late, or may not detect them at
all. The system is not a substitute for a wellrested and attentive driver.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
Ryour
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rjourney-related parameters, e.g. time of
day, length of journey
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Z
201
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
202
Driving and parking
Rif
you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving slower
than 80 km/h or faster than 180 km/h
Rif you are currently using COMAND Online
or making a telephone call with COMAND
Online
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 225).
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, you will be
warned no sooner than 20 minutes after
your journey has begun. You then hear an
intermittent warning tone twice and the
Attention Assist: Take a break!
message appears in the multifunction display.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a or % button to confirm
the message.
X
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break, you will be warned again
after 15 minutes at the earliest. This will only
happen if ATTENTION ASSIST still detects
typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration.
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts
assessing your tiredness again when you continue your journey if:
Ryou
switch off the engine
Ryou take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
Speed Limit Assist
General notes
Speed Limit Assist shows you detected speed
limits in the multifunction display. Data from
the navigation system is also used for this
purpose. If a traffic sign indicating a speed
limit or the end of a speed limit is detected, it
is shown in the multifunction display. If Speed
Limit Assist does not detect any traffic signs,
the speed limit from the digital road map is
taken and shown in the display.
Speed Limit Assist detects the traffic signs
with a camera attached behind the top of the
windscreen.
: Speed Limit Assist camera
Important safety notes
Speed Limit Assist is only an aid and does not
always detect traffic signs specifying the
maximum permissible speed. Traffic signs
always have priority over the Speed Limit
Assist display.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun or from
oncoming traffic
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Rthe traffic signs are covered, for instance by
dirt, snow or trees
Driving systems
traffic signs are poorly illuminated
are ambiguous traffic signs, for
instance near roadworks or on multi-lane
roads
Rthere
Information in the multifunction display
Briefly showing detected traffic signs in
the multifunction display
X
Activate the Speed Limit Assist warning
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 223).
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit appears in the multifunction display for around five seconds as
soon as it is detected. Any other information in the multifunction display is hidden
for this period.
Permanently showing detected traffic
signs in the multifunction display
Display the assistance graphic using the
on-board computer (Y page 223).
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit appears in the multifunction display as soon as it is detected.
Traffic sign : indicating a speed limit is generally displayed until:
X
Ra traffic sign indicating the end of the speed
limit is detected.
make a turn.
Ryou leave or enter a town.
Rthe road type changes (e.g. motorway,
country road).
Ryou have travelled a certain minimum distance without the traffic sign being repeated or detected again.
Ryou
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 203) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 205).
: Maximum permissible speed (example)
; Maximum permissible speed for vehicles
subject to the restriction in the additional
sign (example)
= Additional character in fog
? Speed Limit Assist is available and
switched on
Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system
to monitor the areas on both sides of your
vehicle. It supports you from speeds of
30 km/h. A warning display in the exterior
mirrors draws your attention to vehicles
detected in the monitored area. If you then
switch on the corresponding turn signal to
change lane, you will also receive an optical
and audible collision warning. For this purpose, Blind Spot Assist uses sensors in the
rear bumper.
Z
Driving and parking
Rthe
203
204
Driving systems
Important safety notes
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles:
Rovertaken
too closely on the side, placing
them in the blind spot area
Rwhen the difference in the speed of
approach and overtaking is too great
As a result, Blind Spot Assist cannot warn
drivers in these situations. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and maintain a safe distance at the side
of the vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to
detect some vehicles and is no substitute for
attentive driving.
Monitoring range of the sensors
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired in the case of:
Rdirt
on the sensors or obscured sensors
Rpoor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy rain or
snow
narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle or a bicycle
Rvery wide lanes
Rnarrow lanes
Rvehicles not driving in the middle of their
lane
Rbarriers or other road boundaries
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Ra
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next to
your vehicle, as shown in the diagram. For this
purpose, Blind Spot Assist uses radar sensors
in the rear bumper.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case if the vehicles are driving on the inner
side of their lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for
example lorries, for a prolonged time.
The two sensors for Blind Spot Assist are
integrated into the sides of the rear bumper.
Make sure that the bumper is free of dirt, ice
or slush in the vicinity of the sensors. The
radar sensors must not be covered, for example by cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a severe impact or in the event of damage to the bumpers, have the function of the
radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise not work properly.
Driving systems
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
If Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up in red. This warning
always occurs when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the
corresponding turn signal, a double warning
tone sounds. Red warning lamp : flashes. If
the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles
are indicated by the flashing of red warning
lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Activating Blind Spot Assist
Make sure that Blind Spot Assist is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 225).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
X
Towing a trailer
If you attach a trailer, make sure that you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated. The indicator lamp lights up yellow in the exterior mirrors and the Blind
Spot Assist currently unavailable
See Owner's Manual message appears in
the multifunction display.
i You can deactivate the indicator lamps in
the exterior mirrors.
To do so, deactivate Blind Spot Assist if:
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
Rthe
engine is not running
electrical connection to the trailer
has been established
Rthe
Lane Keeping Assist
General notes
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of camera :
at the top of the windscreen. Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
Z
Driving and parking
Indicator and warning display
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
approximately 30 km/h. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
205
Driving and parking
206
Driving systems
can warn you before you leave your lane unintentionally.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you by
means of intermittent vibration through the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist cannot always clearly
identify lane markings.
In these cases, Lane Keeping Assist may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and keep in lane, especially if Lane
Keeping Assist alerts you.
Rnot
G WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist warning does not
return the vehicle to the original lane. There is
a risk of an accident.
Always steer, apply the brakes or accelerate
the vehicle yourself, especially if Lane Keeping Assist alerts you.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Lane
Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of
an accident nor override the laws of physics.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot take into account
road, weather or traffic conditions. Lane
Keeping Assist is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front,
for vehicle speed, for braking in good time,
and for staying in lane.
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun or reflection from other vehicles
(e.g. if the road surface is wet)
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up, damaged or covered, for instance by a sticker,
in the vicinity of the camera
Rno, or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge
Rthe road is narrow and winding
Rthere are highly variable shade conditions
on the road
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
X Activate Lane Keeping Assist using the onboard computer; to do so, select Standard
or Adaptive (Y page 225).
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, the lane markings in the assistance graphics display
(Y page 223) are shown in green.
When Standard is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou
have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
When Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou
have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
Ryou
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
Towing a trailer
Notes on towing a trailer
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There is
a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
G WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle/trailer
combination if it begins to swerve. The vehicle/trailer combination could even overturn.
There is a risk of an accident.
On no account should you attempt to
straighten out the vehicle/trailer combination by increasing speed. Decrease your
speed and do not countersteer. Brake if necessary.
G WARNING
If the maximum the permissible load for a carrier system is exceeded, the carrier could
come loose from the vehicle and endanger
other road users. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Never exceed the permissible noseweight
when using a carrier.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
RCLA
180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
45 AMG 4MATIC
Exceeding the maximum permissible noseweight of the trailer drawbar on the ball coupling may cause damage to the following:
RCLA
Ryour
vehicle
trailer
Rthe ball coupling
Rthe trailer tow hitch
The vehicle/trailer combination could
become unstable.
If the noseweight used is lower than the minimum permissible noseweight, the vehicle/
trailer combination could also become unstable.
Rthe
Z
207
Driving and parking
Towing a trailer
Driving and parking
208
Towing a trailer
To avoid hazardous situations:
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Rmake
Ris
sure to check the noseweight before
each journey.
Ruse a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum noseweight.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
noseweight.
Rdo not use a noseweight lower than the
minimum permissible trailer drawbar noseweight.
When reversing the vehicle towards the
trailer, make sure there is nobody between
the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If
you do not couple the trailer to the towing
vehicle correctly, the trailer could become
detached.
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe permissible trailer drawbar noseweight
Rthe
permissible trailer load
Rthe permissible rear axle load of the towing
vehicle
Rthe maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
The applicable permissible values, which
must not be exceeded, can be found:
Rin
your vehicle documents
Ron the identification plates of the trailer tow
hitch and the trailer
Ron the vehicle identification plate
If the values differ, the lowest value applies.
You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the vehicle identification plates
and those for the towing vehicle under "Technical data" (Y page 364).
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer.
heavier
restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability
Rhas an increased braking distance
Ris affected more by strong crosswinds
Rdemands more sensitive steering
Rhas a larger turning circle
This can impair the vehicle's handling characteristics. Adapt your driving style accordingly. Maintain a safe distance. Drive carefully.
When towing a trailer, always adjust your
speed to the current road and weather conditions. Do not exceed the maximum permissible speed for your vehicle/trailer combination.
Ris
General notes
X
When towing a trailer, set the tyre pressure
on the rear axle of the towing vehicle for a
maximum load; see the tyre pressure table
in the fuel filler flap (Y page 330).
Please note that when towing a trailer, PARKTRONIC (Y page 188) and Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 203) availability is limited or not available at all.
i The height of the ball coupling changes
with the load of the vehicle. If necessary,
use a trailer with a height-adjustable drawbar.
You will find fitting dimensions and loads
under "Technical data" (Y page 363).
Driving tips
i Observe the notes on ESP® trailer stabilisation (Y page 71).
The maximum permissible speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations depends on the type of
trailer. Before beginning the journey, check
the trailer's documents to see what the maximum permitted speed is. Observe the legally
Towing a trailer
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
vehicle speed. This relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly. If you
need additional braking, depress the brake
pedal repeatedly rather than continuously.
i Briefly depressing the accelerator pedal
on downhill gradients while the manual
drive program M is temporarily activated
(vehicles with automatic transmission): the
automatic transmission may switch back to
the last active automatic drive program E or
S. The automatic transmission may shift to
a higher gear. This can reduce the engine's
braking effect.
Driving tips
If the trailer swings from side to side:
Do not accelerate.
Do not countersteer.
X Brake if necessary.
X
X
RMaintain
a greater distance from the vehicle in front than when driving without a
trailer.
RAvoid braking abruptly. If possible, brake
gently at first to allow the trailer to run on.
Then, increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe values given for gradient-climbing
capabilities from a standstill refer to sea
level. When driving in mountainous areas,
note that the power output of the engine,
and consequently the vehicle's gradientclimbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.
Folding out the ball coupling
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Before you can tow a trailer with your vehicle,
you must fold out the ball coupling.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the boot.
Z
Driving and parking
prescribed maximum speed in the relevant
country.
For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased
when towing a trailer. Refer to the "Technical
data" section to find out whether this applies
to your vehicle. If you utilise any of the added
maximum rear axle load when towing a trailer,
the vehicle/trailer combination may not
exceed a maximum speed of 100 km/h for
reasons concerning the operating permit.
This also applies in countries in which the
permissible maximum speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations is above 100 km/h.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer and it will
consume more fuel.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. For vehicles
with automatic transmission, you need to
have selected manual drive program M
(Y page 160).
209
Towing a trailer
210
Always engage the ball coupling as described.
Pull the ball coupling in the direction of the
arrow until it engages in a vertical position.
Indicator lamp ? goes out. The power
socket folds down automatically.
The multifunction display shows the
Check trailer hitch lock display message until the ball coupling is engaged.
X Remove the protective covering from the
ball coupling and store it in a safe place.
X Make sure that the ball of the ball coupling
is clean and that it is either greased or dry
(grease free), depending on the instructions for the trailer.
Driving and parking
X
X
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise and fold down cover ; and
remove it.
Coupling up a trailer
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Position the trailer level behind the vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X Establish the electric connection between
the vehicle and the trailer.
X Check that the trailer lighting system is
working.
A trailer that is connected is recognised
only when the electrical connection is
established correctly and when the lighting
system is working properly. The function of
other systems, such as ESP® or PARKTRONIC also depends on this.
X
X
X
Pull out release wheel =.
Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise as far
as it will go.
The ball coupling disengages and folds out
behind the rear bumper. Indicator lamp ?
flashes.
Uncoupling a trailer
G WARNING
If the ball coupling is not correctly engaged,
the trailer can detach. There is a risk of an
accident.
G WARNING
If you uncouple a trailer with an engaged overrun brake, you could trap your hand between
the vehicle and the trailer drawbar. This poses
a risk of injury.
Do not uncouple a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake.
Towing a trailer
X
engaged overrun brake. Otherwise, your
vehicle could be damaged by the rebounding of the overrun brake.
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise and fold down cover ; and
remove it.
! Remove the installed adapter cable
before folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear
bumper and the adapter cable.
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Secure the trailer against rolling away.
X Remove the trailer cable and decouple the
trailer.
X
Folding in the ball coupling
G WARNING
If you release the ball coupling or it does not
engage correctly when folding in, it will swing
out. Within pivoting range of the ball coupling,
there is an increased risk of an accident and
injury.
Only release the ball coupling if the pivoting
range is unobstructed. Always make sure that
the ball coupling engages when folding in.
Fold the ball coupling back in if you are not
using the trailer tow hitch.
X Place the protective covering on the ball
coupling.
Pull out release wheel =.
X Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise as far
as it will go.
The ball coupling disengages and folds out
behind the rear bumper. Indicator lamp ?
flashes.
X
X
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the boot.
X
Press the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow until it engages behind the
bumper.
Indicator lamp ? goes out and the message in the multifunction display disappears.
Trailer power supply
! You can connect accessories with a
power rating of up to 240 W to the permanent power supply and with a power rating
of up to 180 W to the power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
Z
Driving and parking
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an
211
Towing a trailer
212
The trailer battery may not be charged from
the power supply.
Driving and parking
X
To switch the connected power supply
on or off: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or 0 respectively.
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's
trailer socket is equipped with a permanent
power supply and a power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin
10.
The trailer's permanent power supply is
switched off in the event of low vehicle supply
voltage and after six hours at the latest.
You can find more information about installing the trailer electrics at a qualified specialist workshop.
Fitting the adapter
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable
play so that the cable cannot become
detached when cornering.
! Remove the installed adapter cable
before folding in the ball coupling. Otherwise, damage may occur to the rear
bumper and the adapter cable.
Open the socket cover.
Insert the plug connector with lug : into
groove = on the socket. Turn bayonet connection ; clockwise to the stop.
X Let the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure
the cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
X
Bulb failure indicator for LED lamps
i If LED lamps are fitted in the trailer, an
error message may appear in the multifunction display even if there is no fault. The
reason for the error message could be that
the current has fallen below the minimum
of 50 mA.
To ensure reliable operation of the bulb failure
indicator, each LED chain in the trailer lighting
must be guaranteed a minimum current of
50 mA.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
General notes
Trailer with 7-pin connector: you can connect to the 13-pin socket on the ball coupling
using an adapter or, if necessary, an adapter
cable. Both can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Useful information ............................ 214
Important safety notes .................... 214
Displays and operation .................... 214
Menus and submenus ...................... 217
Display messages ............................. 234
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................ 263
On-board computer and displays
213
On-board computer and displays
214
Displays and operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognise function
restrictions relevant to safety. The operating
safety of your vehicle may be impaired. There
is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating the on-board computer.
The on-board computer only shows messages
or warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make
sure your vehicle is operating safely at all
times. Otherwise, a vehicle that is not operating safely may cause an accident.
For an overview, see the instrument panel
illustration (Y page 30).
Displays and operation
Instrument cluster lighting
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted using the brightness control knob.
The brightness control knob is on the bottom
left of the instrument cluster (Y page 30).
X Turn the brightness control knob clockwise
or anti-clockwise.
If the light switch is set to Ã, T or
L, the brightness is dependant upon
the brightness of the ambient light.
i The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of
the multifunction display.
In daylight, the displays in the instrument
cluster are not illuminated.
Coolant temperature gauge
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the right-hand side.
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
Displays and operation
Operating the on-board computer
On-board computer and displays
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
Overview
Rev counter
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Speedometer with segments
The speedometer is divided into segments on
vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS.
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RCruise
control activated (Y page 173):
The segments light up from the stored
speed to the maximum speed.
RVariable SPEEDTRONIC activated
(Y page 176):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 178):
One or two segments in the set speed
range light up.
RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front:
The segments between the speed of the
vehicle in front and the stored speed light
up.
: Multifunction display
; Switches on LINGUATRONIC, see the sep-
arate operating instructions
= Right control panel
? Left control panel
A Back button
X
215
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
Z
On-board computer and displays
216
Displays and operation
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
9
:
a
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
RSelects a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects a
stored station, an audio track or
a video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
Press and hold:
RIn
the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects
an audio track or a video scene
using rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling through the
phone book
W
X
RAdjusts
8
RMute
the volume
Back button
%
Press briefly:
RBack
RSwitches
off LINGUATRONIC,
see the separate operating
instructions
RHides display messages
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Multifunction display
RConfirms selection/display mes-
sage
the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RIn the Audio menu: stops the
station search function at the
desired station
RIn
Right control panel
~
RRejects
or ends a call
telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
6
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
Multifunction display (example: vehicles with automatic transmission)
: Permanent display: outside temperature
or speed (Y page 226)
; Time
= Text field
? Menu bar
A Drive program (Y page 156)
B Transmission position (Y page 156)
X
To show menu bar ?: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
Menu bar ? disappears after a few seconds.
Text field = shows the selected menu or
submenu as well as display messages.
i You can set the time using the audio system or COMAND Online; see the separate
operating instructions.
The following messages may appear in the
multifunction display:
Z
Gearshift recommendation, for
manual transmission
(Y page 155) or automatic transmission (Y page 160)
XjY
Active Parking Assist
(Y page 192)
¯
Cruise control (Y page 173)
È
SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 175)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 115)
¤
ECO start/stop function
(Y page 150)
ë
HOLD function (Y page 186)
120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
RAssist.
menu (assistance) (Y page 223)
menu (Y page 225)
RSettings menu (Y page 225)
RAMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 231)
The Audio
Audio, Navi and Tel menus differ slightly
in vehicles with an audio system and in vehicles with COMAND Online. The examples
given in this Owner's Manual apply to vehicles
equipped with COMAND Online.
RServ.
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; is shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 215).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 217)
menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 219)
RAudio menu (Y page 220)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 221)
RNavi
Example: "From start" trip computer
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
reset
X
Z
217
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
218
Menus and submenus
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 218).
The From start trip computer is automatically reset when:
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours.
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 9,999 hours or
99,999 kilometres.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
approximate range and the current fuel
consumption (not for AMG vehicles).
X
The approximate range that can be covered is
calculated according to your current driving
style and the amount of fuel in the tank. If
there is only a small amount of fuel left in the
fuel tank, the display shows a vehicle being
refuelled C instead of the range.
Digital speedometer
ECO display
: Gearshift recommendation, manual trans-
Example: ECO display
mission (Y page 155) or automatic transmission (Y page 160)
; Digital speedometer
The ECO display is not available for AMG vehicles.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ECO DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
Gearshift recommendation : is not given on
AMG vehicles.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than four hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
For further information on the ECO display,
see (Y page 170).
Resetting values
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Example: resetting the "From start" trip computer
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip
meter
start" trip computer
R"From
R"From
reset" trip computer
display
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press the a button.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
RECO
i If you reset the values in the "ECO dis-
play", the values in the "From start" trip
computer are also reset. If you reset the
values in the "From start" trip computer,
the values in the "ECO display" are also
reset.
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
:
;
=
?
Distance to the destination
Distance to the next change of direction
Current road
Symbol indicating "follow the road's
course"
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online, see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
X
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. For more
information, see the separate operating
instructions.
Route guidance not active
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is announced, you
will see symbol = for the change of direction
and distance graphic ;. This shortens
towards the top of the display as you
approach the point of the announced change
of direction.
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Z
219
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
220
Menus and submenus
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
;
=
?
A
B
leads
Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction (white)
Lane not recommended (dark grey)
Possible lane
Change-of-direction symbol
On multilane roads, new lane recommendations can be displayed for the next change of
direction if the digital map supports this data.
During the change of direction, new lanes
may be added.
Recommended lane =: in this lane you will
be able to complete the next change of direction and the one after that.
Lane not recommended ?: you will not be
able to complete the next change of direction
if you stay in this lane.
Possible lane A: you will be able to complete
the next change of direction in this lane only.
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO: you have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
RNew route... or Calculating route:
route
calculating a new route
ROff map or Off road:
road the vehicle position
is outside the area of the digital map (offmap position).
RNo route:
route no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
: Waveband
; Station frequency with memory position
The memory position is only displayed along
with station ; if this has been stored.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select Radio; see the separate
operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a station from the station list:
press and briefly hold the 9 or :
button.
If no station list is received:
X To select a station using the station
search: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
i For information on changing waveband
and storing stations, see the separate operating instructions.
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting); see the separate operating instructions.
Audio player or audio media operation
Example: CD changer display
: Current track
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select audio CD, audio DVD or
MP3 mode; see the separate operating
instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired track : has
been reached.
If you press and hold the 9 or :
button, the rapid scrolling speed is
increased. Not all audio devices or media
support this function.
X
If track information is stored on the audio
player or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and title of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select video DVD; see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene : has
been reached.
X
Telephone menu
Introduction
G WARNING
Operating the integrated information systems
and communications equipment in the vehicle
while driving will distract you from traffic conditions. You could then lose control of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate these devices if road traffic conditions permit. If you are unsure about the
surrounding conditions, pull over to a safe
location and make entries only while the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the
legal requirements for the country in which
you are currently driving.
X Switch on your mobile phone and audio
system or COMAND Online, see the separate operating instructions.
X Place a mobile phone in the mobile phone
bracket (Y page 286), or establish a Bluetooth® connection with the audio system or
COMAND Online, see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
Example: DVD changer display
Z
221
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
222
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease
enter PIN
PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
but the PIN has not been entered.
When you enter your PIN via the mobile
phone, LINGUATRONIC, the audio system
or COMAND Online, the mobile phone
searches for a network.
RTelephone ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service:
service there is no network available or the mobile phone is
searching for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rfrom
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
Accepting a call
Example: incoming call
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call even if you are not in the
Tel menu.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
You can end or reject a call even if you are not
in the Tel menu.
Dialling an entry from the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
To start rapid scrolling, press and hold the
9 or : button for longer than one
second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make the call: press
the ~ or % button.
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X
X
Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
Assistance graphic
or
X
If you do not want to make the call: press
the ~ or % button.
Assistance menu
Introduction
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assistance
graphic.
graphic
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the DISTRONIC PLUS distance display in the assistance graphic.
X
In the Assist. menu, you have the following
options:
RShowing the assistance graphic
(Y page 223)
RActivating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function (Y page 223)
RActivating/deactivating ESP®
(Y page 224)
RActivating/deactivating the distance warning function (Y page 224)
RActivating/deactivating COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS (Y page 224)
RActivating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST (Y page 225)
RActivating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 225)
RActivating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 225)
The assistance graphic shows you the status
of and/or information from the following driving systems or driving safety systems:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 184)
ASSIST (Y page 201)
RLane Keeping Assist (Y page 205)
RSpeed Limit Assist (Y page 202)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST distance
warning function (Y page 65)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
(Y page 67)
RATTENTION
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Speed Limit Assist.
Assist
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
224
Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
When the Speed Limit Assist message
function is activated, the assistance
graphic shows the Ä symbol.
If the Speed Limit Assist message function
is activated, a detected speed limit is automatically displayed for five seconds. Other
items in the multifunction display are not
shown during this time.
X
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 267).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 235).
Activating/deactivating the distance
warning function
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Distance
warning.
warning
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When the distance warning function is activated, the Ä symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphic
display.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Further information on the distance warning
function (Y page 65).
Rwhen
Activating/deactivating COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Observe the "Important safety notes" section
in the description of ESP® (Y page 68).
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Deactivating/activating ESP® on AMG vehicles (Y page 70).
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 68).
X Start the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ESP.
ESP
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning
lamp in the instrument cluster lights up
continuously when the engine is running.
Rin
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Collision Prevent. Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
PLUS is activated, the Ä symbol
appears in the multifunction display in the
assistance graphic display.
X
For further information about COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, see (Y page 67).
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ATTENTION ASSIST.
ASSIST
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is activated, the
À symbol appears in the assistance
graphic in the multifunction display.
X
Press the : or 9 button to set Off
Off,
Standard or Adaptive
Adaptive.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When Lane Keeping Assist is activated, the
multifunction display shows the lane markings as bright lines in the assistance
graphic.
X
For further information about Lane Keeping
Assist; see (Y page 205).
Service menu
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 201).
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
For further information about Blind Spot
Assist, see (Y page 203).
When the Blind Spot Assist Sensors
deactivated message is shown, the radar
sensors are deactivated.
X Switch on the radar sensor system
(Y page 229).
In the Serv menu, you have the following
options:
RCalling up display messages in the message memory (Y page 234)
RRestarting the tyre pressure loss warning
system (Y page 332)
RChecking the tyre pressure electronically
(Y page 332)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 295)
Settings menu
Introduction
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Lane Keeping Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X Press a to confirm.
X
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
Rchanging the instrument cluster settings
Rchanging the light settings
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
226
Rchanging
the vehicle settings
the auxiliary heating settings
(Y page 229)
Rchanging the convenience settings
Rrestoring the factory settings
Rchanging
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
You can determine whether the multifunction
display shows some messages in miles or kilometres.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
miles
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rthe
digital speedometer in the Trip menu
total distance recorder and the trip
meter
Rthe trip computer
Rthe current consumption and the range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rthe
Switching the additional speedometer
on/off
The Dig. speedometer [mph] or Dig.
speedometer [km/h] function (vehicles for
the United Kingdom) allows you to choose
whether the multifunction display in the sta-
tus area always shows the speed in mph or in
km/h instead of the outside temperature.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dig. speedometer [mph] or Dig.
speedometer [km/h] (United Kingdom)
function.
You will see the selected setting: on or off
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Selecting the permanent display function
You can determine whether the multifunction
display permanently shows your speed or the
outside temperature.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display function.
You will see the selected setting outside
temperature or Dig. speedometer
[mph]/Dig.
[mph]
Dig. speedometer [km/h] (vehicles for the United Kingdom).
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
i The speed is displayed in mph or in km/h
(United Kingdom).
Lights
Switching the daytime driving lights
on/off
The Daytime driving lights function can
only be switched on with the engine turned
off.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
Press a to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Daytime driving lights function.
If the Daytime driving lights function
has been switched on, the cone of light and
the W symbol in the multifunction display are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
X
Further information on daytime driving lights
(Y page 111).
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intell. Light System function.
If the Intell. Light System function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you activate the Intell. Light Sys‐
tem you activate the following functions:
tem,
RMotorway mode
RActive light function
RCornering light function
RExtended range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, the multifunction
display shows the Intell. Light System:
system inoperative Inactive for
left-side traffic or Intell. Light
System: System inoperative Inactive
for right-side traffic display message
instead of the Intell. Light Sys. function
in the Lights submenu (Y page 227).
Further information on the Intelligent Light
System (Y page 114).
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dipped beams Setting for: function.
You will see the selected setting: Rightside traffic or Left-side traffic.
traffic
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does
not take place until the next time the vehicle is stationary.
This function is only available on vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 110).
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
unavailable.
You can also have the dipped-beam headlamps set for driving on the right/left at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light +/- function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Change the setting with a.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to a level from Off to Level 5
(bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Z
227
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
228
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
If you have activated the Surround light‐
ing function and the light switch is set to
Ã, the following functions are activated
when it is dark:
Rsurround lighting: the exterior lighting
remains lit for 40 seconds after unlocking
with the key. If you start the engine, the
surround lighting is switched off and automatic headlamp mode is activated
(Y page 111).
Rexterior lighting delayed switch-off: the
exterior lighting remains lit for 60 seconds
after the engine is switched off. If you close
all the doors and the boot lid, the exterior
lighting goes off after 15 seconds.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Surround lighting function.
When the Surround lighting function is
activated, the light cone and the area
around the vehicle are displayed in orange
in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting temporarily:
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is
deactivated.
X
Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is
reactivated the next time you start the
engine.
i Depending on your vehicle's equipment,
when the surround lighting and delayed
switch-off exterior lighting are on, the following light up:
Rside lamps
Rfoglamps
Rdipped-beam headlamps
Rdaytime driving lights
Rsurround lighting in the exterior mirrors
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Lighting delayed sw.off function, the interior lighting remains on
for 20 seconds after you remove the key from
the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lights submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Lighting delayed sw.-off function.
If the Lighting delayed sw.-off function has been switched on, the vehicle interior is displayed in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can set permanent SPEEDTRONIC using
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres) function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust
permanent SPEEDTRONIC in increments of
ten (240
240 km/h to 160 km/h).
km/h The Off set-
ting switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC
off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
For further information on permanent SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 177).
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door locks function.
When the Automatic door locks function is activated, the vehicle doors are displayed in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you activate the Automatic door locks
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above
a speed of approximately 15 km/h.
For further information on the automatic locking feature, see (Y page 85).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function,
an acoustic signal sounds when you lock the
vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar sensor (See Owner's Man.).
Man.)
You will see the selected setting: on or off
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If the radar sensor system is switched off,
Blind Spot Assist is deactivated (Y page 203).
Heating
Auxiliary heating departure time
G WARNING
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
parts of the vehicle can become very hot.
Flammable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with:
Rhot
parts of the exhaust system
exhaust gas itself
There is a risk of fire.
When the auxiliary heating is switched on,
make sure that:
Rthe
Rno
flammable materials come into contact
with hot vehicle components
Rthe exhaust gas can escape from the
exhaust pipe unhindered
Rthe exhaust gas does not come into contact
with flammable materials.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
Only vehicles with auxiliary heating
(Y page 138) have this function.
Z
229
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
230
Menus and submenus
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off. The auxiliary
heating adopts the THERMATIC or
THERMOTRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by
using the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
off (no timer active).
X Press a to confirm.
If a departure time is selected, the yellow
indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
Changing the departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select A, B
or Change C.
C
Press a to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
X
Comfort
Switching belt adjustment on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
If the Belt adjustment function is activated, the vehicle seat belt is shown in orange
in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
For further information on belt adjustment,
see (Y page 48).
Switching the fold in mirrors when locking function on/off
This function is only available on vehicles with
a memory function (Y page 107).
When you activate the Auto. fold-in mir‐
rors function, the exterior mirrors are folded
in when the vehicle is locked.
When you unlock the vehicle and then open a
door, the exterior mirrors fold out again.
If you have switched on the Auto. fold-in
mirrors function and you fold in the exterior
mirrors using the button on the door
(Y page 105), they will not fold out automatically. The exterior mirrors can then only be
folded out using the button on the door.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold-in mirrors function.
If the Auto. fold-in mirrors function is
activated, the vehicle's exterior mirror is
displayed in orange in the multifunction
display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Resetting to factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No
or Yes
Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset
the Daytime driving lights in the Lights
submenu, you must turn the key to position 1
in the ignition lock.
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
:
;
=
?
A
B
X
Digital speedometer
Gear indicator
Upshift indicator
Engine oil temperature
Coolant temperature
Transmission fluid temperature
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator UP = indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual gearshift program.
Upshift indicator UP = fades out other messages until you have shifted up.
If the engine oil temperature is below 80 †,
oil temperature ? is shown in blue. Avoid
using the full output of the engine during this
time.
If the transmission fluid temperature is below
50 †, oil temperature B is shown in blue.
Avoid using the full output of the engine during this time.
SETUP
: Drive program (C
C/S
S/M
M)
; ESP® mode (ON
ON/OFF
OFF) or SPORT handling
mode (SPORT
SPORT)
Z
231
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
232
SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program) mode and the
SPORT handling mode.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until
SETUP is displayed.
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X
Starting a new lap
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
: Lap
; RACETIMER
The RACETIMER is only intended for use on a
closed race circuit. Do not use the function on
public roads.
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position 2
in the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
Lap
i A maximum of 16 laps may be stored. The
16th lap can only be completed with Fin‐
ish Lap.
Lap
Stopping the RACETIMER
X
Displaying the intermediate time
Press the % button on the steering
wheel.
X Confirm Yes with a.
X
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop
the vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in
the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position
2 or 3 and then press a to confirm Start
Start,
timing is continued.
Resetting the current lap
X Stop the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
Lap
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
Deleting all laps
Lap evaluation
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER is
reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If
you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap
does not have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset
Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
:
;
=
?
A
Overall evaluation
:
;
=
?
A
Lap
Lap time
Average lap speed
Lap length
Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
X
RACETIMER overall evaluation
Total time driven
Average speed
Distance covered
Maximum speed
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
X
Z
233
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
234
Display messages
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on the HOLD function
(Y page 186) and parking (Y page 167).
Hiding display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call
up the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages,
messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST/
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes:
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Rself-diagnosis
Rthe
is not yet complete.
on-board voltage may be insufficient
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and ESP® trailer stabilisation are unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST/
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
Z
235
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
236
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST/
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The self-diagnosis function, for example, may not be complete.
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST/
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
T!
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRESAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST/
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
237
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
238
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds. A
condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not
fulfilled (Y page 168).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
Release parking
brake
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are making an emergency stop using the electric parking
brake (Y page 168).
!
Parking brake See
Owner's Manual
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
X Press the electric parking brake handle for at least ten seconds.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red ! indicator lamp are
lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
or
Vehicles with manual transmission (automatic emergency
release): insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate
slightly more when pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: release the electric
parking brake automatically (Y page 168).
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
X
Do not drive on.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red ! indicator lamp continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 336).
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the kerb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake:
Vehicles with manual transmission (automatic emergency
release): insert the seat belt in the belt buckle and accelerate
slightly more when pulling away.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: release the electric
parking brake automatically (Y page 168).
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
239
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
240
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red ! indicator lamp
flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. It is not possible to
apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red ! indicator
lamp flashes for about ten seconds after the electric parking brake
Parking brake inop‐ has been applied or released. It then goes out or remains lit.
erative
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by
charging the battery or restarting the engine.
X Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be applied or released:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply or release the electric parking brake.
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The red ! indicator lamp flashes and the yellow ! warning
lamp is lit.
It is not possible to apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: engage first gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift the transmission
to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Turn on the igni‐
tion to release
the parking brake
The red ! indicator lamp lights up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition was switched off.
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
Vehicles with manual transmission: a malfunction has occurred
while the HOLD function was activated.
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. If you attempt to lock
the vehicle, the tone becomes louder.
You cannot start the engine.
X Paying attention to the traffic situation, immediately depress the
brake pedal firmly and hold until the display message disappears.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
You can restart the engine.
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
Brake immediately
Check brake fluid
level
G WARNING
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the fault.
#
Check brake pad
wear
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
242
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Collision Preven‐
tion Assist Plus
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
front bumper is dirty
Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
RAMG vehicles: ESP® is deactivated
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Clean the front bumper (Y page 300).
X Restart the engine.
X AMG vehicles: reactivate ESP® (Y page 70).
X
Collision Preven‐
tion Assist Plus
inoperative
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS is malfunctioning. The distance warning signal may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Brake Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
front bumper is dirty
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
RAMG vehicles: ESP® is deactivated
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Adaptive Brake Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Clean the front bumper (Y page 300).
X Restart the engine.
X AMG vehicles: reactivate ESP® (Y page 70).
X
PRE-SAFE
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
Adaptive Brake Assist is faulty. The distance warning signal may
also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PRE-SAFE
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
ü
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been inserted into a rear seat belt buckle.
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 49).
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
244
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ý
If this symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been inserted in a rear seat belt buckle.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or which has not been
engaged in the seat belt buckle correctly, cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts (Y page 48).
Further information on the status indicator for the rear seat belts
(Y page 49).
6
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) is malfunctioning. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Restraint sys. mal‐
G WARNING
function Consult
workshop
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Further information on occupant safety (Y page 40).
6
SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Front left malfunc‐
G WARNING
tion Consult work‐
shop or Front
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintenright malfunction
tionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
Consult workshop
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Rear right
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand windowbag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusLeft windowbag mal‐ ter.
function Consult
G WARNING
workshop or Right
windowbag malfunc‐ The left or right windowbag may either be triggered unintentionally
tion Consult work‐ or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
shop
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all the LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
Left cornering
(Y page 117).
light or Right cor‐
or
nering light
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
Left dipped beam
or Right dipped
beam
Trailer left tail
lamporTrailer
lamp
Trailer
right tail lamp
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
246
Display messages
Display messages
b
Trailer left indi‐
cator or Trailer
right indicator
b
Trailer brake lamp
b
Rear left indica‐
tor or Rear right
indicator
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
X
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Observe the separate operating instructions provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
tor or Right mir‐
ror indicator
b
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Third brake lamp
Left brake
lamporRight
lamp
Right brake
lamp
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp or
Right-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
Display messages
b
Left main beam or
Right main beam
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The left or right-hand main-beam headlamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The left or right-hand licence plate lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left-hand or right-hand front foglamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Number plate lamp
Left fog
lamporRight
lamp
Right fog
lamp
b
Rear foglamp
The rear foglamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 117).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
Reversing light
Left tail lamp or
Right tail lamp
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
248
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left-hand or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
b
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp or Right
daytime driving
lamp
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
Check the fuses (Y page 322).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes
as you do so.
X
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Switch off lights
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
Rvisibility is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again, the
Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message is
displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is operational again.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing so
(Y page 294).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Wait until the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out
and the coolant temperature is below 120 †. The engine may
otherwise be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Under normal operating conditions and with the specified coolant
level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
Z
249
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
250
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty
alternator
poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Rtorn
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X
4
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 292).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 293).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if the
engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
! Avoid long journeys when there is too little coolant in the cooling system. Otherwise the engine will be damaged.
Information on approved engine oils can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at http://
bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
æ
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ç
There is very little fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
Reserve fuel level
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
Replace air cleaner
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you
get enough rest.
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
Speed Limit Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Speed Limit Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Speed Limit Assist is operational again.
Speed Limit Assist
inoperative
ë
Off
Speed Limit Assist is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The HOLD function is deactivated. the vehicle is skidding
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 186).
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
252
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is not fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 186).
Radar sensor deac‐
tivated See Own‐
er's Manual
The radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Switch on the radar sensor system (Y page 229).
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
Rthere are no lane markings for a longer period.
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Lane Keeping Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rvisibility
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 167).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe sensors are dirty
Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 167).
X Clean the sensors (Y page 300).
X Restart the engine.
Blind Spot Assist is deactivated while towing a trailer.
You have established the electrical connection between the trailer
and your vehicle.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative
Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist cancel‐ The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
led
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while
steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
254
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 192).
Park Assist inoper‐ You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking
manoeuvres.
ative
Active Parking Assist will become available again after approximately ten minutes (Y page 192).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 178). If it was
deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 178).
DISTRONIC PLUS cur‐ DISTRONIC PLUS is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
rently unavailable Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow
See Owner's Manual
Rthe sensors in the radiator trim are dirty
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 167).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator trim (Y page 300).
X Restart the engine.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty. Adaptive Brake Assist may also have
failed.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS
inactive
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
- - - km/h
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 180).
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
SPEEDTRONIC and cruise control are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Limit
--- km/h
While depressing the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point
(kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC cannot be activated.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
Cruise control
- - - km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 174).
120 km/h!
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!.
km/h!
X Drive more slowly.
Z
255
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
256
Display messages
Tyres
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Ryou have changed the positions of the wheels and tyres or fitted
new wheels and tyres.
tyre pressure in one or more tyres is not correct.
Rthe
G WARNING
Tyre pressures which are too low, harbour the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 167).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 308).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre
pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 332).
Check tyre pres‐
sures
then restart Run
Flat Indicator
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 332).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
X
Rectify tyre pres‐
sure
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 332).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 334).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
Tyre pressures which are too low, harbour the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 167).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 308).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 332).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Warning tyre defect The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle
could lose control of the vehicle
Rcontinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling away (Y page 167).
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 308).
Ryou
Z
257
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
258
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. moni‐
tor currently
unavailable
Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have suitable tyre pressure sensors. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer
being charged.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop at the next opportunity.
X Until then, set the automatic transmission to position P before
you switch off the engine.
X Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
Depress brake to
start engine
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position N without depressing the brake pedal.
X
Depress the brake pedal.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To shift out of P
or N,
depress brake and
start engine
You have attempted to shift the transmission to position R or D
without starting the engine.
X Start the engine.
X Depress the brake pedal.
i It is only possible to shift the transmission from position P to
the desired position if you depress the brake pedal. Only then
can the parking lock be deactivated. If you do not depress the
brake pedal, the DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved but the
parking lock remains engaged.
i At transmission fluid temperatures below Ò20 † you can only
shift out of position P into another transmission position when
the engine is running.
Apply brake to
deselect Park (P)
position
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position R, N or D without depressing the brake pedal.
Risk of vehicle
rolling
Transmission not
in P
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N or
D.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
Without changing
gear,
consult workshop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
X
Depress the brake pedal.
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Only select Park
(P)
when vehicle is
stationary
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning. You cannot drive in
Reversing not
poss. Consult work‐ reverse.
shop
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
259
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
260
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Transmission Mal‐
function
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Transmission Mal‐
function Stop
The automatic transmission is malfunctioning.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Stop vehicle Shift
to P Leave engine
running
The automatic transmission has overheated.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the automatic transmission
is available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Wait until the automatic transmission has cooled down and the
display message goes out.
X
Trans. oil overhea‐ AMG vehicles: the transmission oil has overheated.
ted Drive on with
Manual drive program M and the temporarily active manual drive
care
program are no longer available. Engine power output is reduced.
X Allow the vehicle to cool down.
4matic currently
unavailable
4MATIC (permanent all-wheel drive) has overheated. The vehicle is
only driven by the front wheels.
X Drive on.
The airflow cools 4MATIC more quickly.
When the display message goes out, 4MATIC is available again
and the vehicle is driven by all four wheels.
4matic inoperative
4MATIC is malfunctioning. The vehicle is only driven by the front
wheels.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
M
The bonnet is open.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Close the bonnet.
Active bonnet mal‐
function See Own‐
er's Manual
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a
malfunction or because it has already been triggered.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
j
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Engage the trailer coupling's ball coupling in the end position
(Y page 209).
Check trailer
hitch lock
Otherwise, the trailer may become detached.
Ð
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
Power steering mal‐
G WARNING
function See Own‐
er's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Z
261
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
262
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
&
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 138).
X Drive for a considerable distance.
The battery charges. The auxiliary heating is operational again as
soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
&
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank. The auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on (Y page 138).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
inoperative Bat‐
tery low
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
&
inoperative See
Owner's Man.
The auxiliary heating has a temporary malfunction or is faulty.
When the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down, make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting several minutes between each attempt
(Y page 138).
X If the auxiliary heating does not switch on, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
X
Telephone No ser‐
vice
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid
i If, during the winter months, you do not add antifreeze to the
washer fluid, it may freeze in the washer fluid container. In this
case, the Top up washer fluid display message may appear
in the multifunction display.
X
Top up the washer fluid (Y page 295).
Wiper malfunction‐
ing
The windscreen wipers are defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Hazard warning
lamps malfunction‐
ing
The hazard warning lamps are faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
+
The key needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Replace key
On-board computer and displays
Key
263
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
Only for certain countries: the red seat belt
warning lamp lights up
for six seconds after
the engine starts.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
to fasten their seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
ü
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
Only for certain coun- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
tries: the red seat belt
The warning tone ceases.
warning lamp lights up
after the engine starts.
In addition, a warning
tone sounds for up to
six seconds.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
The red seat belt warn- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
ing lamp lights up after
The warning lamp goes out.
the engine starts, as
soon as the driver's or There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
the front-passenger
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
door is closed.
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
Z
On-board computer and displays
264
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the
The red seat belt warn- same time, you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly
ing lamp flashes and an driven faster than 25 km/h.
intermittent audible
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 46).
warning sounds.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
The red brake system
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
Braking
efficiency may be impaired.
the engine is running. A
There is a risk of an accident.
warning tone also
sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) has been deactivated due to a fault.
Therefore, BAS (Brake Assist), COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST,
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, ESP® (Electronic Stability
Program), PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the
adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example,
are also deactivated.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will be unavailable.
Z
265
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
266
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, ESP®,
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD
function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer
stabilisation, for example, are also deactivated.
Possible causes:
Rself-diagnosis
is not yet complete.
on-board voltage may be insufficient
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Rthe
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running. A
warning tone also
sounds.
EBD is faulty. Therefore, ABS, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION
ASSIST, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, ESP®,
PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake
lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example, are not available
either.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J֌!
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning. Therefore, BAS, COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS,
EBD, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive
brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example, are not
available either.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock, for example, if you brake hard.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance may increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
267
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
268
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
The yellow ESP® warn- skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
ing lamp flashes while Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
the vehicle is in motion. X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 68).
å
ESP® and ESP® trailer stabilisation are deactivated. ESP® will not
®
stabilise the vehicle if it starts to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
The yellow ESP OFF
warning lamp is lit while G WARNING
the engine is running.
If ESP® is deactivated, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
Reactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 68).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
M
AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is switched on, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Only switch on SPORT handling mode in certain situations
(Y page 70).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS, PRE‑SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start
assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation are
not available due to a malfunction.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights and COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST/
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS may also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance may thus increase in an emergency braking
situation.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased danger of skidding and risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
269
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
270
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The red indicator lamp
for the electric parking
brake flashes or is lit
and/or the yellow
warning lamp for the
electric parking brake
is lit.
X
6
The red SRS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) is malfunctioning.
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have SRS checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
For further information about the Supplemental Restraint System,
see (Y page 41).
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be
running in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry
(Y page 166).
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
æ
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
warning lamp is on
drops into the reserve range.
while the engine is run- X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ning.
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
271
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
272
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator may
be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant (Y page 294).
Observe the warning notes as you do so.
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is
below 120 †. The engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
In addition, steam from an overheated engine can cause serious
burns, which can occur just by opening the bonnet.
There is a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant (Y page 294).
Observe the warning notes as you do so.
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
The red distance warn- selected.
ing lamp lights up while X Increase the distance.
the vehicle is in motion.
·
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line
The red distance warn- of travel at too high a speed.
ing lamp lights up while X Be prepared to brake immediately.
the vehicle is in motion. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
A warning tone also
brake or take evasive action.
sounds.
Further information about the distance warning function of COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST (Y page 65).
Further information about COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST PLUS
(Y page 67).
Z
273
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
274
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Tyres
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) is lit.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 167).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tyre (Y page 308).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 332).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp (pressure loss/
malfunction) flashes for
approximately one
minute and then
remains lit.
The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to recognise or register low tyre
pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
275
Useful information ............................ 276
Loading guidelines ............................ 276
Stowage areas .................................. 276
Stowing and features
Features ............................................. 282
276
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowing and features
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, especially
when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the boot
lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion. There is a risk
of poisoning.
Always switch off the engine before opening
the boot lid. Never drive with the boot lid
open.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rnever
exceed the maximum permissible
gross vehicle weight or the permissible axle
loads for the vehicle (including occupants).
Rthe boot is the preferred place to carry
objects.
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Ruse the lashing eyelets and the luggage
nets to transport loads and luggage.
Ronly use lashing eyelets and fastening components that are suitable for the weight and
size of the load.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. Pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Lashing material is available at any qualified specialist workshop.
Stowage areas
Stowage spaces
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not correctly store objects in the
vehicle interior, they can slip or be flung
around, thus striking vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, especially when braking or abruptly changing directions.
Stowage areas
Spectacles compartment
flung around in these or in similar situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage compartments, luggage nets or stowage nets.
RClose lockable stowage compartments
while driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the boot.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276).
Front stowage compartments
Glove compartment
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
i There is a pen holder at the top of the
glove compartment flap.
X
To open: press marking :.
Make sure that the spectacles compartment
is always closed while the vehicle is in motion.
Stowage compartment in the centre console
Illustration: vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
To open: press the marking on cover :.
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there may be an ashtray in the centre console instead of the stowage compartment.
X
Z
Stowing and features
RAlways store objects so that they cannot be
277
Stowage areas
278
Stowage compartment in front of the armrest (vehicles with automatic transmission)
audio equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or MP3
player (see the separate Audio or COMAND
Online operating instructions).
Stowing and features
Stowage compartment under the driver's
and front-passenger seat
Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
X
To open: press the marking on cover :.
i You can remove the non-slip mat and the
insert for cleaning. When removing the
insert you will have to overcome some
slight resistance.
G WARNING
If you exceed the maximum permitted load of
the stowage compartment, the cover is
unable to restrain the objects. Objects may be
thrown out of the stowage compartment and
hit vehicle occupants as a result. There is a
risk of injury, particularly in the event of sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Always observe the maximum load of the
stowage compartment. Stow and secure
heavy objects in the boot.
The maximum permissible load of the stowage compartment is 1.2 kg.
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
X
To open: on vehicles with moveable armrests, make sure that the armrest is in the
rearmost position.
X Press button : and fold the armrest up.
X
i Depending on the vehicle equipment, the
armrest can be moved backwards or forwards in a longitudinal direction.
i Depending on the vehicle equipment, a
USB port or a Media Interface is installed in
the stowage compartment. A Media Interface is a universal interface for portable
To open: pull handle : up and fold
cover ; forwards.
i On vehicles with a fire extinguisher
instead of a stowage compartment, the fire
extinguisher is installed under the driver's
seat.
Stowage areas
279
Rear stowage compartments
X
X
X
To open: pull down the top of stowage
compartment : by the edge of the handle.
To open: fold down seat armrest :.
Pull the centre head restraint on the rear
bench seat into the uppermost position
(Y page 101).
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there may be an open stowage space above
the stowage compartment.
Luggage nets
Luggage nets are located:
Rin
the front-passenger footwell
the back of the driver's and frontpassenger seat
Ron the left and right-hand side in the boot
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276)
and the safety notes regarding stowage
spaces (Y page 276).
Ron
Through-loading facility in the rear
compartment
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276).
Slide locking mechanism = in the direction of the arrow.
X Swing flap ; fully to the side.
Flap ; is held open by a magnet.
X
To close: swing flap ; in the boot back
until it engages.
X Fold armrest : up fully if necessary.
X
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold forwards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
Z
Stowing and features
Stowage compartment in the rear centre
console
Stowage areas
280
Stowing and features
RThe
vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt cannot protect as intended and
could result in additional injury.
RObjects or loads in the boot cannot be
restrained by the seat backrest.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged before every trip.
X
X
Fold backrest : forwards.
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
! Before folding the backrest in the rear
compartment forwards, make sure that the
rear compartment armrest and the
cupholder are folded in. They may otherwise be damaged.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276).
X
Insert the seat belt into seat-belt
extender :.
Folding the rear seat backrest back
Folding the rear seat backrest forwards
and back
Folding the rear seat backrest forward
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded forwards separately to
increase the boot capacity.
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
X
Fully insert the backrest head restraints
(Y page 102).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Pull left-hand or right-hand release handle ; of the seat backrest forwards.
The corresponding seat backrest : is
released.
X
Fold seat backrest : back until it engages.
Red lock status indicator ; is no longer
visible.
Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 102).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Stowage areas
281
Securing a load
Lashing eyelets
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
the loading guidelines
(Y page 276).
RSecure the load using the lashing eyelets.
RDistribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
RDo not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load. These are only intended as an antislip protection for light loads.
RDo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
RPad sharp edges for protection.
: Lashing eyelets
Stowage well under the boot floor
Under the boot floor you can find a bracket for
TIREFIT and the vehicle tool kit, etc.
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
To enlarge the boot you can remove the boot
floor.
X
To remove: lift the boot floor almost to rain
trough ; and pull it out.
To insert: place the boot floor at the bottom in the centre.
X Hold sides of boot floor = and press in the
direction of the arrow until it engages in
hooks ?.
X
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When a load is transported on the roof, the
vehicle's centre of gravity rises and the handling changes. If you exceed the maximum
roof load, the handling as well as steering and
braking characteristics are severely affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X
To open: pull handle : up.
Z
Stowing and features
RObserve
Features
282
Always observe the maximum roof load and
adapt your driving style.
Stowing and features
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that when the roof carrier is fitted
you can:
Ropen
Ropen
the panorama sliding sunroof fully
the boot lid fully
The maximum roof load is 75 kg.
An incorrectly secured roof carrier or roof
load may become detached from the vehicle.
You must therefore ensure that you observe
the roof carrier manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Attaching the roof carrier
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Fold covers : upwards.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The cup holder cannot secure a drinks container in place during a journey. If you use a
cup holder during a journey, the drinks container could be flung around and liquid could
be spilt. Vehicle occupants could come into
contact with the liquid and, in particular, be
scalded by hot liquid. You could be distracted
from the traffic situation and lose control of
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident and
injury.
Only use the cup holder when the vehicle is
stationary. Only place containers of a suitable
size in the cup holder. Seal the container, in
particular when it contains hot liquid.
G WARNING
If you do not correctly store objects in the
vehicle interior, they can slip or be flung
around, thus striking vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, especially when braking or abruptly changing directions.
RAlways store objects so that they cannot be
flung around in these or in similar situations.
RAlways make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage compartments, luggage nets or stowage nets.
RClose lockable stowage compartments
while driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the boot.
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The
drinks could otherwise spill.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 276).
Features
Rfront:
capacity up to 1.0 l
Rrear: capacity up to 0.5 l
Cup holders in the front centre console
Two coin holders = and a card holder ; can
be found in the cup holder.
The cup holder and the rubber mat underneath can be removed for cleaning. Clean
them with clean, lukewarm water only.
X To remove: lift the cup holder up : and
out with a brief tug.
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit on or support your body weight
on the rear seat armrest when it is folded
down, as you could otherwise damage it.
! Close the cup holder before folding the
rear seat armrest up. Otherwise, the cup
holder could be damaged.
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
To open: press the front of cup holder :
or ;.
Cup holder : or ; extends automatically.
X To close: slide cup holder : or ; back
until it engages.
X
X
Sun visors
Overview
To fit: insert cup holder : into lateral
curved sections ; in the stowage compartment. Simultaneously insert the cup
holder in such a way that the wedge of the
upper section of the cup holder faces forwards.
X Press cup holder : downwards until it
engages on the right and left-hand sides.
X
:
;
=
?
A
Mirror light
Retainer
Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Vanity mirror
Mirror cover
Z
Stowing and features
The stowage compartments in the doors provide space for bottles:
283
Features
284
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Rear-compartment ashtray
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A
has been folded up.
Glare from the side
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
Stowing and features
X
X
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
To open: pull cover = out by its top edge.
To remove: pull insert ; by recess : in
the direction of arrow ? until it audibly
releases.
X Lift insert ; up and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert ; from above
into the holder and press down until it
engages.
X
X
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
Rthe
Example: vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover
To open: push the lower section of
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X To remove the insert: lift insert = up ;
and out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X
i If you remove the ashtray insert, you can
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unattended in the vehicle.
Ra
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
Features
285
Example: vehicles with a stowage compartment
cover
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X To open: push the lower section of
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
Stowing and features
Socket in the front centre console
Vehicles with a stowage compartment cover
To open: push the lower section of
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X
12 V sockets
Points to observe before use
X
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as bulbs or chargers
for mobile phones.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
Vehicles without a stowage compartment cover
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
i An emergency cut-off ensures that the onboard voltage does not drop too low. If the
on-board voltage is too low, the power to
the sockets is automatically cut. This
ensures that there is sufficient power to
start the engine.
Z
Features
286
X
X
Pull cover : out by its top edge.
Lift up the cover of socket ;.
Stowing and features
Socket in the boot
sion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rthat mutual interference between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones is minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial
Information on retrofitting two-way radios
and mobile phones (RF transmitters)
(Y page 352).
Rthe
X
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Operating mobile communications equipment while driving distracts you from paying
attention to traffic conditions. This could also
cause you to lose control of the vehicle. There
is a risk of an accident.
Use this device only when the vehicle is stationary.
i You must observe the legal requirements
for the country in which you are currently
driving when operating mobile communications equipment in the vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so if the traffic situation permits. You may otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause
an accident and injure yourself and others.
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discus-
General notes
There are various mobile phone brackets that
may be fitted in your vehicle; in some cases,
these are country-specific.
You can connect a Bluetooth®-capable
mobile phone with Audio 20 or COMAND
Online via the Bluetooth® interface. This also
applies if your vehicle is equipped with convenience telephony.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with
Audio 20 or COMAND Online can be obtained:
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Ron
i The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Using a mobile phone
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, the mobile phone will be
Features
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 221).
When you remove the key from the ignition
lock, the mobile phone is disconnected from
the hands-free system. Active calls will first
be transferred to the mobile phone directly.
To fold the bracket up: press button :.
X To fold the bracket down: press the
bracket down and allow it to engage.
X
Floormat on the driver's side
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell may restrict
the clearance around the pedals or block a
depressed pedal. This jeopardises the operating and road safety of the vehicle. There is a
risk of an accident.
Stow all objects securely in the vehicle so that
they do not get into the driver's footwell.
Always fit the floormats securely and as prescribed in order to ensure that there is always
sufficient room for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place several floormats on top of one another.
Mobile phone bracket in the stowage
compartment
You can fold the pre-installed bracket up to
improve access to the stowage space
beneath it. Depending on the vehicle equipment, a USB port or a Media Interface is
installed in the stowage compartment
(Y page 278).
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press safety catch knobs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat away from
retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
X
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
Z
Stowing and features
charged and connected with the exterior aerial.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 278).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the
pre-installed fitting; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting.
287
288
Features
Stowing and features
You can obtain information about anti-glare
film from a qualified specialist workshop.
289
Useful information ............................ 290
Engine compartment ........................ 290
Service ............................................... 295
Maintenance and care
Care .................................................... 297
290
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Maintenance and care
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An unlocked bonnet may open while driving
and block your view. There is a risk of an accident.
Never unlock the bonnet while driving.
G WARNING
When being opened and closed, the bonnet
may suddenly fall into the closed position.
There is a risk of injury to persons in the range
of movement of the bonnet.
Open and close the bonnet only when nobody
is in the range of movement.
G WARNING
If you open the bonnet while the engine is
overheating or while there is a fire in the
engine compartment, you could come into
contact with hot gases or other leaking service products. There is a danger of injury.
Allow an overheating engine to cool down
before opening the bonnet. If there is a fire in
the engine compartment, leave the bonnet
closed and notify the fire brigade.
G WARNING
There are moving components in the engine
compartment. Certain components may continue to move or suddenly move again even
after the ignition has been switched off, e.g.
the radiator fan. There is a risk of injury.
If you have to carry out work in the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
off the ignition
Rnever touch the dangerous areas surround-
ing moving components, e.g. the rotation
area of the fan
Rremove jewellery and watches
Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts.
G WARNING
The ignition system and the fuel injection system operate with a high voltage. If you touch
the live components, you could receive an
electric shock. There is a danger of injury.
Never touch components of the ignition system or the fuel injection system when the
ignition is switched on.
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
! An active bonnet that had been triggered
must be repaired at a qualified specialist
workshop. The active bonnet function will
then be available again. The additional
pedestrian protection provided by the
active bonnet will then be restored.
The active bonnet is only available in certain
countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury
to pedestrians in certain accident situations.
Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to hard components, such as the engine.
If the active bonnet has been triggered, it is
raised at the rear in the area around the hinge
by approximately 60 mm.
For the drive to the workshop, reset the triggered active bonnet yourself. If the active
Engine compartment
Resetting
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
X
With your hand flat, push down active bonnet : in the area around the hinges on
both sides (arrows) until you feel it engage.
If you can raise the active bonnet slightly in
the area around the hinges, it is not engaged
correctly. Repeat the step.
If the bonnet can then still be raised, drive
directly to a qualified specialist workshop. Do
not drive faster than 100 km/h.
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
Reach into the gap between the bonnet and
the radiator trim and press bonnet catch
lever ; to the left.
X Raise the bonnet.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
bonnet has been triggered, pedestrian protection may be limited.
291
Engine compartment
292
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rif the engine is not at normal operating
temperature, e.g. if the engine was only
started briefly, wait approximately
30 minutes before carrying out the measurement.
Maintenance and care
Rthe
X
X
Pull support strut ? out of bracket A.
Lift up support strut ? and insert it into
yellow retaining clip =.
Closing the bonnet
Raise the bonnet slightly and, at the same
time, remove support strut ? from yellow
retaining clip =.
X Swing support strut ? down and press it
into bracket A until it engages.
X Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Do not press the bonnet
closed. Open the bonnet again and close it
with a little more force.
X
Engine oil
General notes
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 litres of oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
Engine compartment
293
Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and
MAX mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark =
or below, top up with 1.0 l of engine oil.
X
Adding engine oil
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine (except
CLA 180 CDI model)
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that engine oil does not spill out
over the filler neck. Allow the engine to cool
down and thoroughly clean the components
that have come into contact with engine oil
before you start the engine.
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
Example: CLA 180 CDI model
All models except the CLA 180 CDI: pull
out oil dipstick :.
X CLA 180 CDI model: release the oil filler
cap and pull it out together with integrated
oil dipstick :.
X
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that
have been approved for vehicles with a service system. You can obtain a list of the
engine oils and oil filters tested and
approved in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Z
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
Engine compartment
294
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that have
not been specifically approved for the
service system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by
the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. Topping up with
Maintenance and care
too much engine oil can result in damage to
the engine or to the catalytic converter.
Have excess engine oil siphoned off.
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
The engine cooling system is under pressure,
particularly if the engine is warm. You could
be scalded by hot coolant spraying out when
opening the cap. There is a danger of injury.
Allow the engine to cool before opening the
cap. Wear gloves and protective eyewear
when opening. Slowly turn the cap half a turn
to allow pressure to escape.
! The coolant level must only be checked
and corrected when the engine has cooled
down (coolant temperature under 40 †).
Checking the coolant level when the coolant temperature is over 40 † can lead to
damage to the engine or engine cooling
system.
Example: engine oil filler cap
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark on
the oil dipstick, top up with 1.0 l of engine
oil.
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick (Y page 292).
X
X
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 359).
Example
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle is
on a level surface and the engine has
cooled down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
40 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X
Service
Slowly turn cap : half a turn anti-clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
295
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 360).
Topping up the windscreen washer system/headlamp cleaning system
G WARNING
Certain components in the engine compartment could be very hot, e.g. the engine, the
radiator and parts of the exhaust system.
There is a risk of injury when accessing the
engine compartment.
As far as possible, allow the engine to cool
down and only touch the following components.
G WARNING
Windscreen washer concentrate is highly
flammable. If it comes into contact with hot
engine components or the exhaust system it
could ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that no windscreen washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.
Example
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
X
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
If the washer fluid level drops below the recommended minimum of 1 litre, a message
appears in the multifunction display prompting you to refill the washer fluid (Y page 262).
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 361).
Service
ASSYST PLUS
Service messages
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 292).
Z
Maintenance and care
X
Service
296
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
Maintenance and care
RService
A in .. days
RService A due
RService A overdue by .. days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until
the next service due date is displayed.
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter.
Only for certain countries: the position after
the letter A or B indicates any necessary additional maintenance work to be performed. If
you notify a qualified specialist workshop of
this display, you will receive a statement on
the associated costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
Hiding service messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
Press the = or ; button to select the
Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by
pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval display has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out. You
can also obtain further information on maintenance work, for example.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on
normal operation of the vehicle. Service work
will need to be performed more often if the
vehicle is operated under arduous conditions
or increased loads, for example:
Rregular city driving with frequent intermedi-
ate stops
the vehicle is primarily used to travel
short distances
Rfor frequent operation in mountainous terrain or on poor road surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
In these or similar operating conditions, have
the air filter, engine oil and oil filter, for examRif
Care
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. You can
obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Care
General notes
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
Rabrasive
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Care of the exterior
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after the vehicle
has been washed. There is a risk of an accident.
After washing the vehicle, brake carefully
while paying attention to the traffic conditions
in order to restore full braking efficiency.
! If DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function
is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle, deactivate DISTRONIC
PLUS and the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
! Make sure that the automatic transmis-
sion is in position N when washing your
vehicle in a tow-through car wash. The vehicle could be damaged if the transmission is
in another position.
! Make sure that:
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed/
airflow control is turned to position 0).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
Z
Maintenance and care
ple, changed more frequently. The tyres must
be checked more frequently if the vehicle is
operated under increased loads. Further
information can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
297
298
Care
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Maintenance and care
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at wash bays that are specially
designed for this purpose. Observe the legal
requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Relectrical
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X
Care
The following cannot always be completely
repaired:
Rscratches
Rcorrosive
deposits
Rareas affected by corrosion
Rdamage caused by inadequate care
In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed
by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo
and plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of approved Mercedes-Benz
care products.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do
not touch the insides of the windows with
hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
RVigorous
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matt finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
Z
Maintenance and care
Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
X
299
Care
300
Cleaning the wiper blades
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
If the windscreen wipers are set in motion
when cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, you could become trapped. There is a
danger of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windscreen or
wiper blades.
Cleaning the mirror turn signal
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
X
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge and a mild cleaning agent,
e.g. Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning cloths.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pres-
sure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
Care
301
! AMG vehicles with black exhaust pipes:
do not use chrome polish to polish black
chromed screens. They will otherwise lose
their silky black shine. Rub the screen using
a lightly oiled cloth after every car wash.
Commercially available engine oils, WD 40
or Ballistol are suitable oils.
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch
i The cover of the camera closes automatically when the key is at position 0 in the
ignition lock.
Cleaning the exhaust pipe
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing.
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with acidbased cleaning agents such as sanitary
cleansers or wheel cleaners.
X
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a highpressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
! Please note the care instructions in the
trailer coupling manufacturer's operating
instructions.
Remove rust, e.g. with a wire brush.
Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or a
brush.
X After cleaning, lightly oil or grease ball coupling :.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer tow hitch is
working properly.
X
X
i Maintenance of the ball coupling and
trailer tow hitch can also be performed at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Clean the exhaust pipe with a care product
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Z
Maintenance and care
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open the cover of the reversing camera: with the audio system/COMAND
Online activated, press the W button.
X Select System by turning cVd the audio
system/COMAND controller and press W
to confirm.
X Select Rear view camera and press W to
confirm.
X Select Open camera cover and press W
to confirm.
The reversing camera cover opens.
X To clean the reversing camera: use clear
water and a soft cloth to clean camera
lens :.
X
Care
302
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Maintenance and care
Rabrasive
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. This could result in plastic
parts breaking away when the airbags are
deployed. There is a danger of injury.
Do not use care products and cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the cockpit.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wooden trim and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements
with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA
covers. If used often, these can damage the
cover.
i Note that regular care is essential to
make sure that the appearance and comfort of the covers are retained over time.
Genuine leather seat covers
Leather is a natural product.
It has natural surface properties, e.g.:
Runevenness in structure
Rmarks caused by growth and injury
Rsubtle colour differences
Care
temperatures above 80 † or in direct sunlight.
These are characteristics of leather and not
material faults.
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
RClean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise
become rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
X
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft
brush or a cleaning agent recommended
and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X
Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Seat covers from other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully, and always wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
RClean DINAMICA covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
G WARNING
Seat belts may be severely weakened if
bleached or coloured. This may lead to the
seat belts, for example, tearing or failing in an
accident. There is an increased risk of injury,
possibly even fatal.
Never bleach or colour seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts at
Z
Maintenance and care
! To retain the natural appearance of the
303
304
305
Useful information ............................ 306
Where will I find...? ........................... 306
Flat tyre ............................................. 308
Battery (vehicle) ................................ 312
Jump-starting .................................... 316
Towing and tow-starting .................. 318
Breakdown assistance
Electrical fuses ................................. 322
Where will I find...?
306
Useful information
Setting up the warning triangle
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Breakdown assistance
ist workshops: (Y page 24).
Where will I find...?
X
X
Warning triangle
Removing/replacing the warning triangle
To remove: open the boot lid.
X Press warning triangle holder : in the
direction of the arrow and open. Lift clip =
and remove warning triangle ;.
X To replace: place warning triangle ; back
into warning triangle holder :.
X Close warning triangle holder : and push
up to secure.
X
Fold feet = out to the side.
Fold side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
press stud :.
First-aid kit
X
Open the boot lid.
X
Remove first-aid kit :.
i Check the expiry date on first-aid kit : at
least once a year. Replace the contents if
necessary, and replace any missing items.
Where will I find...?
307
Necessary tyre-changing tools can include,
for example:
Fire extinguisher
RJack
RWheel
RWheel
chock
wrench
The fire extinguisher is located underneath
the front of the driver's seat.
X Pull tab : upwards.
X Remove fire extinguisher ;.
i Have fire extinguisher ; refilled after
each use and checked every one to two
years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each
individual country.
: Tyre inflation compressor
; Towing eye
= Tyre sealant filler bottle
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 281).
X Use the TIREFIT kit (Y page 309).
X
X
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: the TIREFIT kit is
located in the stowage well under the boot
floor.
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit: the tyrechange tool kit is in the stowage well under
the boot floor.
For vehicles with an emergency spare wheel,
see "Removing the emergency spare wheel"
(Y page 350).
i Apart from some country-specific var-
iants, vehicles are not equipped with tyrechanging tools. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tyre changing tools
are required and approved to perform a
wheel change on your vehicle, consult a
qualified specialist workshop.
i Towing eye ; is located under tyre inflation compressor :.
Vehicles with a tyre-change tool kit
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 281).
X Remove the tyre-change tool kit.
X
X
The tyre-change tool kit contains:
RJack
RWheel
wrench
pair of gloves
RFolding wheel chock
ROne
Breakdown assistance
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
308
Flat tyre
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
Breakdown assistance
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat char-
acteristics) (Y page 308)
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 307)
Ran emergency spare wheel (only for certain
countries)
Information on changing/fitting a wheel
(Y page 336).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 167).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle a suitable distance away (Y page 306). Observe legal
requirements.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
General notes
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres. The affected
tyre must not show any clearly visible damage.
You can recognise MOExtended tyres by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the
tyre wall. You will find this marking next to the
tyre size designation, the load-bearing capacity and the speed index.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an active tyre pressure loss
warning system or tyre pressure monitoring
system.
If the pressure loss warning message
appears in the multifunction display:
Robserve the instructions in the display mes-
sages (Y page 256).
the tyre for damage
Rif driving on, observe the following notes
The maximum driving distance is approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially
laden and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
Rcheck
Rspeed
Rroad
condition
temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/manoeuvres, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
Routside
Flat tyre
i When replacing one or all tyres, make
sure that you use only:
Rthe tyre size specified for the vehicle and
Rtyre(s)
marked "MOExtended"
If a tyre has gone flat and cannot be
replaced with an MOExtended tyre, a
standard tyre may be used as a temporary
measure. Make sure that you use the
proper size and type (summer or winter
tyre).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
Rthere
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
TIREFIT kit
Important safety notes
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up to
4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread. You
can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to Ò20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
Z
Breakdown assistance
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
309
Flat tyre
310
RImmediately
change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
Comply with the manufacturer’s safety
instructions on the sticker on the tyre inflation compressor.
Breakdown assistance
Using the TIREFIT kit
TIREFIT sticker, 2-part
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation compressor from the stowage well
underneath the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 307).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker within
the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
Remove filler hose B and plug = from the
bottom section of the tyre inflation compressor housing.
X Slide the yellow filler hose connector into
the mounting on yellow cap A of tyre sealant bottle : until the plug engages.
X With the sealing rings in front, slide yellow
cap A of tyre sealant bottle : into the
mounting of tyre inflation compressor ;
until the cap and both hooks engage.
X
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve.
X Insert plug = into the socket of the cigarette lighter (Y page 284) or into a 12 V
power socket in your vehicle (Y page 285).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 147).
X Press on/off switch ? on the tyre inflation
compressor to ON.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
i First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre.
The pressure may briefly rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X
X
Let the tyre inflation compressor run for a
maximum of ten minutes. The tyre should
then have attained a pressure of at least
200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi).
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than ten minutes at a
Flat tyre
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar, 29 psi)
is achieved, see (Y page 311).
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar, 29 psi)
is not achieved, see (Y page 311).
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out
of the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag that contained the TIREFIT kit.
i If the tyre sealant leaks out, allow it to dry.
It can then be removed like a layer of film.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing,
have it cleaned as soon as possible with
perchloroethylene.
Tyre pressure not reached
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi)
has not been achieved after ten minutes:
If a tyre pressure of 200 kPa (2.0 bar/29 psi)
has been achieved after ten minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of ten minutes, the tyre
pressure must be at least 200 kPa (2.0 bar/
29 psi).
X
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
X
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
X
The maximum speed for a tyre sealed with
tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The upper part of the
TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the instrument cluster where it will be easily seen by
the driver.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can significantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
Breakdown assistance
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
311
Battery (vehicle)
312
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
Breakdown assistance
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
X
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the fuel filler
flap for values.
X
To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist
workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle and the filler
hose replaced as soon as possible at a
qualified specialist workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or fitting,
requires specialist knowledge and the use of
special tools. Therefore, always have work on
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress
pressure release button : next to pressure gauge ;.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
may lead to a malfunction, e.g. a short circuit.
This, in turn, may restrict the functions of the
safety-relevant systems, e.g. the lighting system, ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) or ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program). The operating
safety of your vehicle may then be compromised. You could then lose control of the vehicle, e.g.:
Rwhen
braking
making sudden steering movements
and/or travelling at an inappropriate
speed.
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or similar situation, inform a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. You
should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rwhen
To remove the tyre sealant bottle from the
tyre inflation compressor, press together
the locking tabs on the yellow cap.
X Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant
bottle.
X
Further information about ABS (Y page 64)
and ESP® (Y page 68).
Battery (vehicle)
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged. Electrostatic charge is created, for example:
Rby
wearing synthetic fibre clothing
to friction between clothing and the
seat
Rwhen you pull or push the battery across
carpet or other synthetic materials
Rwhen you rub the battery with a cloth
Rdue
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist
workshop for more information.
! Always have work on the battery carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Should it, in exceptional circumstances, be
absolutely necessary to disconnect the battery yourself, please observe the following:
Rswitch off the engine and remove the
key. Check that all the indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster are off. Otherwise,
you may damage electronic components
such as the alternator, for example.
Rfirst, disconnect the negative terminal
clamp, followed by the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Z
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
313
314
Battery (vehicle)
Breakdown assistance
The vehicle electronics may otherwise be
damaged.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
The battery and the cover of the positive
terminal clamp must be fitted securely during operation.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
WARNING
Fire, naked flames and smoking
are prohibited when handling the
battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing,
in particular gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid splashes
off with clean water. Consult a doctor if necessary.
Wear eye protection.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Like other batteries, the vehicle battery may
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In such cases, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can also charge the battery with a
charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle
parked up for a long period of time.
i When you park the vehicle, remove the
key if you do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little
energy, thus conserving battery power.
i If the power supply has been interrupted,
e.g. if the battery was discharged, you will
have to:
Rset
the clock (audio system/COMAND
Online, see the separate operating
instructions).
Rreset the function for folding the exterior
mirrors in/out automatically, by folding
the mirrors out once (Y page 106).
Keep children away.
Charging the battery
Observe this Owner's Manual.
For safety reasons, Mercedes–Benz recommends that you only use batteries that have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries have greater
impact resistance and as a result there is no
risk of acid burns to occupants when a battery
is damaged in an accident.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Battery (vehicle)
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
315
ity. Read the battery charger's operating
instructions before charging the battery.
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 316).
X Open the bonnet.
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure (Y page 316).
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up
at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case
you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor
charge the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced.
The starting characteristics may be impaired,
especially at low temperatures. Have the
thawed battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Only charge the installed battery with a battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. A battery
charger unit specially adapted for MercedesBenz vehicles and tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz is available as an accessory.
It permits the charging of the battery in its
installed position. Contact a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for information and availabilZ
316
Jump-starting
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a
positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
Breakdown assistance
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the
battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek
medical attention.
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, naked flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jump leads.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Vehicles with a petrol engine: avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise,
the non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter.
If the indicator/warning lamps do not light up at low temperatures, it is very likely that the
discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge
the battery. The service life of a battery that has been thawed may be reduced. The starting
characteristics may be impaired, especially at low temperatures. Have the thawed battery
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Jump-starting
317
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged,
the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump
leads. Observe the following points:
battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
RVehicles with a petrol engine: only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust
system are cold.
RDo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
ROnly use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
RIf the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
Rthe
jump leads are not damaged.
parts of the terminal clamp do not come into contact with other metal parts while the
jump leads are connected to the battery.
Rthe jump leads cannot come into contact with parts which can move when the engine is
running, such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
X Secure the vehicle by applying the electric parking brake.
X Manual transmission: depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to neutral.
X Automatic transmission: shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it.
X Switch off all electrical consumers, e.g. rear window heating, lighting etc.
X Open the bonnet.
Rbare
Z
Breakdown assistance
RThe
Towing and tow-starting
318
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
Press together cover : of positive clamp ; and slide it back.
Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead. beginning with your own battery.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using the
jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive clamp ; and positive terminal =. Begin each time at the contacts on your own vehicle
first.
X Close cover : of positive clamp ; after removing the jump leads.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Breakdown assistance
X
i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at
any qualified specialist workshop.
Towing and tow-starting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Safety relevant functions are restricted or no
longer available if:
Rthe
engine is not running
brake system or power steering is malfunctioning
Rthere is a malfunction in the voltage supply
or the vehicle's electrical system
When your vehicle is towed away or towed
started, you may require considerably more
effort to steer and brake. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such cases use a rigid towing bar. Before
being towed away or tow started, make sure
the steering moves freely.
Rthe
G WARNING
If the weight of the vehicle to be towed or towstarted is greater than the permissible gross
weight of your vehicle:
Rthe
towing eye could detach itself
Rthe vehicle/trailer combination could over-
turn.
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
Information on your vehicle's gross vehicle
weight rating can be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 354).
Towing and tow-starting
PLUS, DISTRONIC PLUS or the HOLD function is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To avoid
damage to the vehicle, deactivate these
systems in the following or similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing away
a car wash
! Only secure the tow cable or tow bar to
the towing eyes or, if available, to the trailer
tow hitch. You could otherwise damage the
vehicle.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
RSecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
RMake sure that the tow rope is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow rope
in the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm). This will make other road
users aware that a vehicle is being
towed.
ROnly secure the tow cable to the towing
eyes or, if available, to the trailer tow
hitch.
RObserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance a distance so that the tow rope
does not sag.
RDo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
For towing distances over 50 km, the front
axle or the entire vehicle must be raised
and transported.
! If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. The transmission
may otherwise be damaged.
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing and tow-starting.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
when towing a vehicle, the transmission must
be in position N.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot shift the transmission to position N
on vehicles with automatic transmission
i Deactivate the automatic locking feature
before the vehicle is towed (Y page 229).
You could otherwise be locked out when
pushing or towing the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection
(Y page 73) before the vehicle is towed.
! Do not use the towing eyes for recovery
purposes as this could damage the vehicle.
If in doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Pull away smoothly when towing away or
tow-starting a vehicle. If the tractive power
is too high, the vehicles could be damaged.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum of
50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must not
be exceeded.
Z
Breakdown assistance
! When COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
319
Towing and tow-starting
320
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
Place the towing eye in the stowage well
under the boot floor (Y page 281).
X Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: replace the tyre
inflation compressor.
X
Towing the vehicle with the front axle
raised
Only vehicles without 4MATIC can be
towed with the front axle raised.
Breakdown assistance
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may either be towed
away with both axles on the ground or be loaded up and transported.
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the front axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Example: covers for towing eye mountings
Remove the towing eye from the stowage
space.
The towing eye is located with the vehicle
tool kit under the boot floor (Y page 281).
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: the towing eye
is located under the tyre inflation compressor.
X Press the mark on cover : inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Remove cover : from the opening.
X Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
X
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch do not have a
bracket at the back for the screw-in towing
eye. If you intend to use the vehicle for towing, fold out the ball coupling (Y page 209)
and secure the towbar to it.
Removing the towing eye
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
X Position the top of cover : in the bumper
and press it in at the bottom until it
engages.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to
neutral.
or
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Deactivate automatic locking (Y page 229).
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 113).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and leave the key in the ignition lock.
X
When towing your vehicle with the front axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 318).
Towing and tow-starting
i In order to signal a change of direction
when towing with the hazard warning lamps
switched on, use the combination switch as
usual. In this case, only the turn signals for
the desired direction flash. When you reset
the combination switch, the hazard warning lamps start flashing again.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: the
automatic transmission automatically shifts
to position P when you open the driver's or
front-passenger door or when you remove the
key from the ignition lock. In order to ensure
that the automatic transmission stays in position N when towing the vehicle, you must
observe the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to
neutral.
X
Vehicles with manual or automatic transmission:
Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 113).
X
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 318).
Transporting the vehicle
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
axle or steering components. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and shift to
neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Move the transmission to position N.
X
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
The towing eyes or trailer tow hitch can be
used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if you wish to transport it.
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
Vehicles with 4MATIC may only be either
towed away with both axles on the ground or
be loaded up and transported.
If the vehicle has transmission damage or
damage to the front or rear axle, have it transported on a transporter or trailer.
In the event of damage to the electrical
system
If the battery is defective, the automatic
transmission will be locked in position P. To
shift the automatic transmission to position
Z
Breakdown assistance
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
321
322
Electrical fuses
N, you must provide power to the vehicle's
electrical system in the same way as when
jump-starting (Y page 316).
Have the vehicle transported on a transporter
or trailer.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Do not tow-start vehicles with automatic
Breakdown assistance
transmission. You could otherwise damage
the automatic transmission.
i You can find information on "Jump-starting" under (Y page 316).
Before tow-starting, the following conditions
must be fulfilled:
Rthe
battery is connected
engine has cooled down
Rthe exhaust system has cooled down
When tow-starting, it is important that you
observe the safety notes (Y page 318) and the
legal requirements in each respective country.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 113).
X Fit the towing eye (Y page 320).
X Secure the rigid towing bar or the towing
rope.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress the clutch pedal fully, engage second gear and continue to keep the clutch
pedal fully depressed.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Tow-start the vehicle.
X Release the clutch pedal slowly; do not
depress the accelerator pedal while doing
so.
X When the engine has been started, immediately depress the clutch pedal fully and
shift to neutral.
Rthe
Pull over at a suitable place and stop the
vehicle safely, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
X Use the electric parking brake to secure the
vehicle and prevent it from rolling away.
X Remove the rigid towing bar or towing rope.
X Remove the towing eye (Y page 320).
X Switch off the hazard warning lamps.
X
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate, bridge or replace a faulty
fuse with a fuse of a higher amperage, the
electric cables could be overloaded. This may
result in a fire. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with specified new
fuses of the correct amperage.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Only use fuses marked with an
"S". Components or systems could otherwise be damaged.
The fuses in your vehicle disconnect faulty
circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on
the circuit and their functions will fail.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings
are listed in the fuse allocation chart.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Electrical fuses
Before replacing a fuse
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 167).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it (Y page 147). All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster must
be off.
X
323
Open the bonnet.
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X To open: open clamps ;.
X Fold cover : up in the direction of the
arrow and remove it.
X
X
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rfuse box in the front-passenger footwell
The fuse allocation chart is on the fuse box in
the front-passenger footwell (Y page 323).
Fuse box in the engine compartment
G WARNING
When the bonnet is open, and the windscreen
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windscreen wipers and
the ignition before opening the bonnet.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
To close: check whether the seal is lying
correctly in cover :.
X Insert cover : at the back into openings
= on the fuse box.
X Fold down cover :.
X Hook clamps ; into the fuse box and
close.
X Close the bonnet.
X
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
To open: remove the floormat from the
front-passenger side.
X Fold out perforated floor covering : in the
direction of the arrow.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
Electrical fuses
324
To release cover =, press retaining
clamp ;.
X Fold out cover = in the direction of the
arrow to the catch.
X Remove cover = forwards.
Breakdown assistance
X
i Fuse allocation chart ? is located on the
lower right-hand side of cover =.
To close: insert cover = on the left-hand
side of the fuse box into the retainer.
Cover = engages in the retainers.
X Fold down cover = until clamps ; lock
audibly.
X Fold back perforated floor covering :.
X
325
Useful information ............................ 326
Important safety notes .................... 326
Operation ........................................... 326
Winter operation ............................... 328
Tyre pressure .................................... 330
Changing a wheel ............................. 335
Wheel and tyre combinations .......... 340
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel ................... 349
326
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or that are not
being used correctly can impair operating
safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rtype
When replacing tyres, make sure to fit the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rtype
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Rimmediately
Rlegal
stipulations
recommendations
Information on dimensions and types of
wheels and tyres for your vehicle can be
found under: (Y page 340).
Information on air pressure for the tyres on
your vehicle can be found:
Rfactory
Ron
the tyre pressure label on the fuel filler
flap (Y page 164)
Runder "Tyre pressure" (Y page 330)
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of wheel
spacers or brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating
permit for the vehicle.
i Further information on wheels and tyres
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
RCheck
the tyre pressures when the vehicle
is heavily laden and, if necessary, adjust.
RWhile driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the wheels or tyres are damaged.
If you suspect that a tyre is defective,
reduce your speed immediately. Stop the
vehicle as soon as possible to check the
Operation
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 330).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 349).
The service life of tyres depends on various
factors, including the following:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rmileage
Rtyre
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
Important safety notes on the tyre
tread
G WARNING
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
Regularly check the wheels and tyres of your
vehicle for damage at least once a month, as
well as after driving off-road or on rough
roads. Damaged wheels can cause a loss of
tyre pressure. Pay particular attention to
damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tyres
Rpunctures
Rtears
in the tyres
Rbulges on tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tyre (Y page 327). If necessary, turn
the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect
the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit
anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Do not fit any
other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rsummer
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tyre load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tyre damage or the tyre bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Therefore, only use tyre types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
Z
Wheels and tyres
wheels and tyres for damage. Hidden tyre
damage could also be causing the unusual
handling characteristics. If you find no
signs of damage, have the wheels and tyres
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
RWhen parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb
or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive
over kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try to do so slowly and at an obtuse
angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the
sidewalls, may be damaged.
327
328
Winter operation
Wheels and tyres
tyre load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
Pay special attention to country-specific
requirements for tyre approval. These
requirements can stipulate a specific tyre
type for your vehicle. Furthermore, the use of
certain tyre types in certain regions and areas
of operation can be highly beneficial. You can
find further information regarding tyres at
specialist tyre retailers, at qualified specialist
workshops or at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
ROnly fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics" section
(Y page 308).
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for
the first 100 km. They only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 349).
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
Only use MOExtended tyres in conjunction
with an activated tyre pressure loss warning
system or tyre pressure monitoring system
and only on tyres specifically inspected by
Mercedes‑Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with
a flat tyre (Y page 308).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 335).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
Winter operation
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tyres will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter. These tyres have
been developed specifically for driving in
snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix an appropriate warning sign in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 177).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 330).
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 331).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 334).
X
X
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 349).
Snow chains
G WARNING
If snow chains are fitted to the rear wheels,
they may scrape against the vehicle body or
chassis components. This could cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres. There is a risk
of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rnever
fit snow chains on the rear wheels
fit snow chains in pairs to the front
wheels.
Ralways
! Vehicles with steel wheels: if you fit
snow chains on steel wheels, you may damage the hub caps. Remove the hub caps
from the relevant wheels before fitting the
snow chains.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rsnow
chains cannot be fitted to all wheeltyre combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre
combinations (Y page 340).
Ronly use snow chains if the road surface is
completely snow-covered. Remove the
snow chains as soon as possible when you
come to a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Rwhen snow chains are fitted, never use
Active Parking Assist (Y page 192).
i You may wish to deactivate ESP®
(Y page 68) when pulling away with snow
chains fitted. This way you can allow the
wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting
action).
Information about driving with an emergency
spare wheel (Y page 349).
Z
Wheels and tyres
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
329
330
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tyres pose the
following risks:
tyres may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure and
check the tyre pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Wheels and tyres
Rthe
Rat
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore embarking on a longer journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rwhen
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is a
risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
RCheck the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
Operation with an emergency spare
wheel (Y page 349).
Operation with a trailer: the applicable
value for the rear tyres is the maximum tyre
pressure value stated in the table inside the
fuel filler flap.
The table inside the fuel filler flap may state
tyre pressures for different load conditions.
These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary;
for more information, please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures stated on the tyre pressure information
label apply for all tyres approved for this vehicle.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the
following tyre pressure information is only
valid for that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tyre pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the
electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre
Tyre pressure
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three
hours and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed at which you are driving and the load on
the tyres, the tyre temperature and thus the
tyre pressure changes by approximately
10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres. Only correct the tyre pressure if it
is too low for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus driving safety (e.g. aquaplaning)
Rcause
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
General notes
message will appear in the multifunction display.
You can recognise the tyre pressure loss
warning in the multifunction display in the
Service menu, by the Run Flat Indica‐
tor active Restart with OK message.
Further information on the message display
can be found under "Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system" (Y page 332).
Important safety notes
The tyre pressure warning system does not
warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure.
Observe the notes on the recommended tyre
pressure (Y page 330).
The tyre pressure loss warning does not
replace the need to regularly check the tyre
pressures. An even loss of pressure on several tyres at the same time cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer.
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of a
loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
Z
Wheels and tyres
pressure can be checked using the on-board
computer.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
331
Tyre pressure
332
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
If you wish to cancel the restart:
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
or
Wheels and tyres
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
Rchanged the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres
for the respective operating conditions.
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the tyre pressure table on the fuel
filler flap.
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set
the correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect
tyre pressure is set, these incorrect values
will be monitored.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 330).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 147).
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
X
Press the % button.
When the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, press the 9 or : button to
select Cancel
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Tyre pressure monitor
General notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the corresponding sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is shown in the
multifunction display. After a few minutes of
driving, the current tyre pressure of each tyre
is shown in the Service menu of the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
Yes
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
Example: current tyre pressure display
For further information on displaying this
message, refer to the "Checking the tyre pressure electronically" section (Y page 333).
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating conditions
(Y page 330). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
Tyre pressure
Rif
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tyre pressure on one or more tyres is significantly too low. The tyre pressure monitor is not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
i In addition to the warning lamp, a mes-
sage appears in the multifunction display.
Further information can be found on
(Y page 256).
If the tyre pressure monitor is malfunctioning,
it may take more than ten minutes for the tyre
pressure warning lamp to inform you of the
malfunction by flashing for approximately one
minute and then remaining lit. Once the fault
has been rectified, the tyre pressure warning
lamp goes out after you have driven for a few
minutes.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the tyre
pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being
operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking the tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 147).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be shown in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle was parked for longer than
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message is shown.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically recognises new
wheels or new sensors. As long as a clear
allocation of the tyre pressure values to the
individual wheels is not possible, the Tyre
pressure monitor active message is
shown instead of the tyre pressure display.
The tyre pressures are already being monitored.
i If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, the
system may continue to show the tyre pressure of the wheel that has been removed
for a few minutes. If this occurs, note that
the value displayed for the position where
Z
Wheels and tyres
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor.
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the reference values taught-in.
Restart the tyre pressure monitor after
adjusting to the cold tyre pressure
(Y page 334). The current pressures are
saved as new reference values. This will
ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 330).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The tyre pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Depending
on how the warning lamp flashes or lights up,
a tyre pressure that is too low or a malfunction in the tyre pressure monitor is indicated:
333
334
Tyre pressure
the spare wheel is fitted is not the same as
the current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a pressure loss in one or more tyres, a warning message is shown in the multifunction display and
the yellow tyre pressure monitor warning light
comes on.
Wheels and tyres
RIf
the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in at least one tyre is
too low and must be corrected at the next
opportunity.
RIf the Tyre pressure Check tyres message appears in the multifunction display,
the tyre pressure in one or more tyres has
dropped significantly and the tyres must be
checked.
RIf the Tyre pressure Caution Tyre
malfunction message appears in the multifunction display, the tyre pressure in one
or more tyres has dropped suddenly and
the tyres must be checked.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the display messages in the "Tyres" section
(Y page 256).
you can also define reference values manually as described here. The tyre pressure
monitor then monitors the new tyre pressure
values.
X Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 330).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure for each tyre or the
Tyre pressures will be displayed
after a few minutes of driving message.
X Press the : button.
The multifunction display shows the Use
current pressures as new reference
values message.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
interchanged, for a short time the tyre pressures may be displayed for the wrong positions. This is rectified after a few minutes of
driving and the tyre pressures are displayed
for the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure. However,
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Brazil
1489-10-4415
Model: MRXMERCTX1
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
0016161/08
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer-NO: DA0047074/10
Morocco
MR5526 ANRT 2010/
27/04/2010
MR6706 ANRT 2011/
17/11/2011
Philippines
ESD-1105558C
Serbia
И 011 12
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
N0140-09
South
Africa
TA-2008/1068
TA-2011/1370
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of flat tyre in the "Flat tyre" section
(Y page 308). Information on driving with
MOExtended tyres in the event of a flat tyre
can be found under "Breakdown assistance"
(Y page 308).
Vehicles with an emergency spare wheel:
in the event of a flat tyre, the emergency
spare wheel is fitted according to the description under "Fitting a wheel" (Y page 336).
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Interchanging the front and rear wheels of
differing dimensions can render the general
operating permit invalid.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notes when changing a wheel
(Y page 335).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5,000 to 10,000 km depending on the
degree of tyre wear. Ensure that the direction
of rotation is maintained.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
335
Changing a wheel
336
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
If a trailer is coupled to the vehicle, uncouple it.
X If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tyre-change tool kit from the
vehicle.
X
X
X
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
i Apart from certain country-specific variaStoring wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Wheels and tyres
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
tions, vehicles are not equipped with a tyrechange tool kit. For information on which
tools are required to perform a wheel
change on your vehicle, consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Necessary wheel-changing tools may
include, for example:
Rjack
Rwheel
Rwheel
chock
wrench
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually
(Y page 168).
X Move the front wheels to the straightahead position.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal fully and engage
first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
move the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X Switch off the engine.
X
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 307).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
Changing a wheel
337
Observe the following when raising the
vehicle:
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
On light downhill gradients: place
chocks or other suitable items in front of
the wheels of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the jack is
used incorrectly, it could tip over while the
vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not suitable for performing maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, secure it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and positioning wheel chocks. Never
release the parking brake while the vehicle
is raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, flat load-bearing underlay must be
used. On a slippery surface, a non-slip
underlay must be used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rdo not open or close a door or the tailgate
while the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Rto
Changing a wheel
338
vehicle has covers fitted next to the jacking
points on the outer sills.
Steel wheel with hub cap
X
Vehicles with steel wheels: carefully
reach into two of the hub cap openings and
remove the hub cap.
Covers, front (example: vehicles with AMG equipment)
AMG vehicles and vehicles with AMG
equipment: fold cover ; upwards.
X Take the ratchet ring spanner out of the
tyre-changing tool kit and place it on the
hexagon nut of the jack so that the letters
AUF are visible.
Wheels and tyres
X
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
X
The jacking points are located just behind the
front wheel arches and just in front of the rear
wheel arches (arrows).
AMG vehicles and vehicles with AMG
equipment: to protect the vehicle body, the
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
Example
Changing a wheel
X
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
339
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
Turn ratchet ring spanner ? until jack =
sits completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn ratchet ring spanner ? until the tyre
is raised a maximum of 3 cm from the
ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
X
Unscrew the wheel bolts.
X
Remove the wheel.
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Place the new wheel on the wheel hub and
push it on.
X
X
Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notices in "Changing a wheel"
(Y page 335).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
Z
Wheels and tyres
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
Wheel and tyre combinations
340
Place the ratchet ring spanner onto the
hexagon nut of the jack so that the letters
AB are visible.
X Turn the ratchet ring spanner until the vehicle is once again standing firmly on the
ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
X
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (:
to A). The specified tightening torque is
130 Nm.
Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle
tools in the vehicle again.
X AMG vehicles and vehicles with AMG
equipment: insert the cover into the outer
sill.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 330).
i Vehicles with a tyre pressure control system: all fitted wheels must be equipped
with functioning sensors.
Wheels and tyres
X
Wheel and tyre combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not fit
used tyres if you have no information about
their previous usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RMO
RBA:
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
tain AMG tyres)
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
You will find a table with recommended tyre
pressures for various operating conditions on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. For
further information on tyre pressure, see
RFA:
Wheel and tyre combinations
341
(Y page 330). Check tyre pressures regularly
and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit
the vehicle:
Rwith
tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
Exception: it is permissible to fit a different
type or make in the event of a flat tyre.
Observe the "MOExtended tyres (tyres with
run-flat characteristics)" section
(Y page 308).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
Wheels and tyres
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel/tyre combinations can be
fitted at the factory in all countries.
Z
342
Wheel and tyre combinations
Tyres
CLA 180
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL12, 13, 14
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y12, 13, 14
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
11 Available
as MOExtended tyres.
of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
13 Not in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
12 Use
Wheel and tyre combinations
343
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
Summer tyres
R 15
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R15 91 H15
BA: 6.5 J x 15 H2 ET 47
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
Wheels and tyres
R 17
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL12, 13, 14
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y12, 13, 14
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 15
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 195/65 R15 91 T M+Si15
BA: 6.5 J x 15 H2 ET 47
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
15 Only
for CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition and R 15 steel wheels (code R00) fitted at the factory.
as MOExtended tyres.
12 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
13 Not in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
11 Available
Z
344
Wheel and tyre combinations
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 200
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL12, 13, 14
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y12, 13, 14
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
11 Available
as MOExtended tyres.
in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
12 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
13 Not
Wheel and tyre combinations
345
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 200 CDI
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL12, 13, 14
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y12, 13, 14
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si11
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
11 Available
as MOExtended tyres.
in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
12 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
13 Not
Z
346
Wheel and tyre combinations
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 220 CDI
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 V11, 16
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL12, 13, 14
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y12, 13, 14
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 16
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/55 R16 91 H M+Si11, 16
BA: 6.5 J x 16 H2 ET 49
11 Available
as MOExtended tyres.
in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
12 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
16 Not in conjunction with Sports package (code 950).
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
13 Not
Wheel and tyre combinations
347
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 250
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 17
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
FA: 225/40 R18 92 Y XL12, 13, 14
RA: 245/35 R18 92 Y12, 13, 14
FA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
RA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50.5
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
11 Available
as MOExtended tyres.
in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
12 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
13 Not
Z
348
Wheel and tyre combinations
CLA 250 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/45 R17 91 V12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
BA: 225/45 R17 91 W11, 12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 52.5
R 18
Tyres
BA: 225/40 R18 92 W
Wheels
XL11, 12, 13, 14
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
Wheels and tyres
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 205/50 R17 93 H XL M+S i11, 13
BA: 6.5 J x 17 H2 ET 49
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 225/40 R18 92 H XL M+Si12, 13
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 52
CLA 45 AMG 4MATIC
Summer tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 235/40 ZR18 95 Y XL12
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
R 19
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 235/35 ZR19 91 Y XL12
BA: 8.0 J x 19 H2 ET 48
12 Use
of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
in combination with the Economy package (code 4U3).
11 Available as MOExtended tyres.
14 Observe the notes on "Large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
13 Not
Emergency spare wheel
349
Winter tyres
R 18
Tyres
Wheels
BA: 215/45 R18 93 V XL M+Si
BA: 7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 42.5
BA: 235/40 R18 95 V XL M+S i12
BA: 8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
RAdapt
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimensions are
different to those of the wheel being
replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimensions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
When using an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size, you must not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
12 Use
General notes
i Apart from some country-specific var-
iants, vehicles are not equipped with an
emergency spare wheel. Emergency spare
wheels are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which emergency spare
wheels are approved for your vehicle, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 330).
The value on the wheel or as given in the
"Wheels and tyres" section (Y page 350) is
valid.
i If you are driving with the collapsible
emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system or the tyre
pressure monitor cannot function reliably.
Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning
system/tyre pressure monitor when the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor:
after mounting an emergency spare wheel,
the system may still display the tyre pressure of the removed wheel for a few
minutes. The value displayed for the mounted emergency spare wheel is not the same
as the current tyre pressure of the emergency spare wheel.
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed
of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel
350
Emergency spare wheel
limitation specified on the emergency spare
wheel.
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
Wheels and tyres
Removing the emergency spare wheel
Vehicles with the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel:
The "Minispare" emergency spare wheel is
secured in emergency spare wheel bag : in
the boot.
X Open the boot lid.
X Release securing straps ; on emergency
spare wheel bag :.
X Remove emergency spare wheel bag :
with the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel.
X Open emergency spare wheel bag : and
remove the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 336).
Technical data
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel
Tyres
Steel wheel
T 125/80 R17 99 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa
(4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 17 H2
ET 19.5
351
Useful information ............................ 352
Information on technical data ......... 352
Vehicle electronics ........................... 352
Identification plates ......................... 354
Service products and capacities ..... 354
Vehicle data ...................................... 362
Technical data
Trailer tow hitch ................................ 363
352
Vehicle electronics
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Information on technical data
General notes
You can find current technical data on the
Internet on our Mercedes‑Benz homepage.
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such
as control units, sensors, actuating components and connector leads, at a qualified
specialist workshop. Vehicle components
may otherwise wear more quickly and the
vehicle's operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
G WARNING
If RF transmitters are tampered with or not
properly retrofitted, the electromagnetic radiation they emit can interfere with the vehicle
electronics. This may jeopardise the operational safety of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
You should have all work on electrical and
electronic components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you use the RF transmitter in the vehicle in
an improper way, its electromagnetic radiation can disrupt vehicle electronics, e.g. if:
Rthe
RF transmitter is not connected to an
exterior aerial
Rthe exterior aerial is fitted incorrectly or is
not a low-reflection aerial
This can jeopardise the operating safety of the
vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the low-reflection exterior aerial fitted at
a qualified specialist workshop. When operating in the vehicle, always connect the RF
transmitter to the low-reflection exterior aerial.
! The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must
be complied with:
Ronly
approved wavebands may be used.
the maximum permissible output in these wavebands.
Ronly approved aerial positions may be
used.
Robserve
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and to the
health of others. The use of an exterior aerial
takes into consideration the scientific discus-
Vehicle electronics
Approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
; Rear roof area
= Rear wing
? Boot lid
i On vehicles with panorama sliding sun-
roof, fitting an aerial to the front roof area is
not permitted.
On the rear wing, it is recommended that
you position the aerial on the side of the
vehicle closest to the centre of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609
(Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for fitting
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting
equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters. Comply with the legal
requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at
the base of the aerial must not exceed the
following values:
Waveband
Maximum
transmission
output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74 - 78 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
35 W
GSM/DCS/PCS
850/900/1800/1900
10 W
UMTS/LTE
10 W
The following can be used in the vehicle without restrictions:
RRF
transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
Rmobile phones (GSM/DCS/PCS/UMTS/
LTE)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
RTrunked
radio/Tetra
cm waveband
RGSM/DCS/PCS
RUMTS/LTE
R70
Z
Technical data
sion surrounding the possible health risk
posed by electromagnetic fields.
Observe the notes on operating mobile
phones (Y page 286).
The following aerial positions may be used for
the correct installation of RF transmitters:
353
Service products and capacities
354
data applicable to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification plate.
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
Technical data
X
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
VIN
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold up floor covering : in front of the
right-hand front seat.
You will see VIN ;.
X
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 354).
Engine number
Example: vehicle identification plate
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
?
A
B
C
D
E
countries)
VIN
Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight (kg)
Maximum permissible mass of vehicle/
trailer combination (kg)
Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is example data. This data is different for every vehicle and can deviate
from the data shown here. You can find the
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. You can obtain further information from
any qualified specialist workshop.
Service products and capacities
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Service product can be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Observe the instructions on the respective
original container when using, storing and disposing off service products. Always store service products in the sealed original container.
Always keep service products out of the reach
of children.
Service products and capacities
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindscreen
washer fluid
Rclimate control system refrigerant
Components and service products must be
matched. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use products tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. They are listed in this
Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Further information can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on the
Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuels are poisonous and hazardous to health.
There is a danger of injury.
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into contact
with skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale fuel
vapours. Keep fuels out of the reach of children.
If you or others come into contact with fuel,
observe the following:
RWash the fuel off any affected areas of skin
with water and soap immediately.
RIf you get fuel in your eyes, rinse them thor-
oughly with clean water immediately. Seek
immediate medical attention.
RIf fuel is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention. Do not induce vomiting.
RChange any clothing that has come into
contact with fuel immediately.
Tank capacity
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment. Missing
values were not available at the time of going
to print.
Model
CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY
Edition
Total capacity
40 l
or
50.0 l
CLA 180 CDI
Models with 4MATIC
56.0 l
All other models
50.0 l
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. If you handle fuel
incorrectly, there is a risk of fire and explosion.
You must avoid fire, naked flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Switch off the engine
and, if applicable, the auxiliary heating before
refuelling.
Z
Technical data
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
355
356
Service products and capacities
Model
Of which
reserve fuel
CLA 180 CDI
AMG vehicles
Approx.
8.0 l
All other models
Approx.
6.0 l
Petrol (EN 228, E DIN 51626‑1)
Technical data
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Do not switch on the ignition
if you accidentally refuel with the wrong
fuel. Otherwise, fuel can enter the fuel system. Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. Notify a qualified specialist
workshop and have the fuel tank and fuel
lines drained completely.
! Only refuel using premium-grade unleaded petrol with at least 95 ROZ/85 MOZ,
that conforms to European standard
EN 228 or E DIN 51626–1 or an equivalent
specification.
Fuel of this specification can contain up to
10 % ethanol.
Fuel that does not conform to EN 228 or
E DIN 51626–1 can lead to increased wear
and damage the engine and exhaust system.
! Only use the fuel recommended. Operat-
ing the vehicle with other fuels can lead to
engine failure.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
RE100 (100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM30 (petrol with 30% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
RPetrol
with additives containing metal
RDiesel
Do not mix such fuels with the fuel recommended for your vehicle. Do not use additives. This can otherwise lead to engine
damage. This does not include cleaning
additives for the removal and prevention of
residue build-up. Petrol must only be mixed
with additives recommended by MercedesBenz; see "Additives". You can obtain further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
CLA 200, CLA 250, CLA 250 4MATIC: as a
temporary measure, if the recommended fuel
is not available, you may also use regular
unleaded petrol with an octane rating of
93 RON/83 MON.
All other models: as a temporary measure, if
the recommended fuel is not available, you
may also use regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 91 RON/82 MON. This may
reduce engine performance and increase fuel
consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle and
sudden acceleration. Never refuel using fuel
with a lower RON/MON.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Information on refuelling (Y page 163).
Service products and capacities
! Premium-grade unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 95 RON/85 MON may be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available. This may
reduce engine performance and increase
fuel consumption. As much as possible,
avoid driving at full throttle.
! Regular unleaded petrol with an octane
rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON may also be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available.
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel
consumption, and the engine power output
is noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full
throttle.
If only regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON or
lower is available, you must have the vehicle adapted to this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10% bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You may refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
CLA 250 4MATIC
! Only refuel using premium-grade sulphurfree unleaded petrol with at least 95 RON/
85 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Additives
! Operating the engine with fuel additives
added later can lead to engine failure. Do
not mix fuel additives with fuel. This does
not include additives for the removal and
prevention of residue build-up. Petrol must
only be mixed with additives recommended
by Mercedes-Benz. Observe the instructions for use in the product description.
More information about recommended
additives can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
fuel brands that have additives.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could
build up in the injection system as a result. In
this case, in consultation with a MercedesBenz Service Centre, the petrol may be mixed
with the cleaning additive recommended by
Mercedes-Benz. Always observe the notes
and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Diesel (EN 590)
Fuel grade
G WARNING
If you mix diesel fuel with petrol, the flash
point of this fuel mixture is lower than that of
pure diesel fuel. When the engine is running,
components in the exhaust system may overheat unnoticed. There is a risk of fire.
Never refuel with petrol. Never add petrol to
diesel fuel.
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590
or is of equivalent quality. Fuel that does
not conform to EN 590 can lead to
increased wear as well as damage to the
engine and exhaust system.
Z
Technical data
AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol
with at least 98 RON/88 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an
equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
357
358
Service products and capacities
! Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
Rheating oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix such fuels with diesel fuel and
do not use any special additives. This can
otherwise lead to engine damage.
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content of
under 50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission
control system could be damaged.
Technical data
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: in countries where only diesel fuel with
a high sulphur content is available, you will
need to carry out your vehicle's oil change
at shorter intervals. More information
about the interval for oil change can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
Information on refuelling (Y page 163).
Low outside temperatures
In winter months, diesel fuel with an improved
cold flow quality is available. In Europe, the
EN 590 standard defines various climatedependent temperature categories. Malfunctions can be avoided by refuelling with diesel
fuel that corresponds to the climatic specifications outlined in EN 590. At unusually low
outside temperatures, it is possible that the
flow characteristics of the diesel fuel could be
insufficient. Accordingly, diesel fuel from
warmer areas may not be suitable for operation in colder climatic conditions.
i Further information on country-specific
fuel properties and fuel types with low-temperature resistance can be obtained from
oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Fuel consumption information
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences, road conditions or
traffic flow
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in the
following situations:
Rat
very low outside temperatures
urban traffic
Ron short journeys
Rin mountainous terrain
Rwhen towing a trailer
Rin
i Only for certain countries: you can find
the current consumption and emission values of your vehicle in the COC documents
(EU CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These
documents are delivered with your vehicle.
The consumption figures were, in each
case, based on the currently applicable version:
Rfor vehicles that comply with standards
up to and including the EURO 4 standard,
in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC
Rfor vehicles that comply with or exceed
the EURO 5 standard, in accordance with
Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007
Service products and capacities
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
CLA 200 CDI
CLA 220 CDI
When handling engine oil, observe the important safety notes on service products
(Y page 354).
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Mercedes-Benz approval is indicated on the
oil container by the inscription "MB Approval"
and the corresponding designation, e.g. MB
Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
Petrol engines: in certain countries, different engine oils can be used, provided that the
maintenance intervals are reduced. For more
information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop. Missing values were not
available at the time of going to print.
MB Approval
229.5
Diesel engines without
a diesel particle filter
228.51,
229.31,
229.51, 229.52
MB Approval
CLA 180 CDI
CLA 200 CDI
CLA 220 CDI
228.3, 228.5,
228.51, 229.3,
229.31, 229.5,
229.51, 229.52
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils
for AMG vehicles.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
Rvehicles
with a petrol engine: MB
Approval 229.1, 229.3 or ACEA A3
Rdiesel engines: MB Approval 229.1,
229.3, 229.5 or ACEA C3
This must only be added once and the
amount must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
Model
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
Replacement
amount
5.6 l
CLA 180 CDI
CLA 200 CDI
CLA 220 CDI
6.5 l
Z
Technical data
General notes
All models
MB Approval
CLA 180 CDI
Engine oil
Petrol engines
Diesel engines with a
diesel particle filter
359
360
Service products and capacities
Model
Replacement
amount
AMG vehicles
5.5 l
All other models
5.8 l
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine
oil. This could damage the engine.
Engine oil viscosity
pockets may form when the brakes are subjected to a heavy load. This would impair braking efficiency. There is a risk of an accident.
Have the brake fluid renewed at the prescribed intervals.
When handling brake fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 354).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found
in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB Approval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at
Technical data
a qualified specialist workshop.
Coolant
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity
rating, it flows slowly; the lower the viscosity,
the faster it flows.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
shows you which SAE classifications are to be
used. The low-temperature properties of
engine oils can be significantly impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or
soot and fuel accretion. It is therefore
strongly recommended to observe regular oil
changes using an approved engine oil with the
appropriate SAE classification.
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid continuously absorbs moisture from the air. This results in the boiling
point of the brake fluid lowering. If the boiling
point of the brake fluid is too low, vapour
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot components in the engine compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Let the engine cool down before you top up
the antifreeze. Make sure that antifreeze is
not spilled next to the filler neck. Thoroughly
clean the antifreeze from components before
starting the engine.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Service products and capacities
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
i Have the coolant regularly replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Service
Booklet.
Comply with the important safety precautions
for service products when handling coolant
(Y page 354).
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It is responsible
for the following:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant during operation will be approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rantifreeze
Rbe at least 50 %. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55 % (antifreeze protection
down to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be
dissipated as effectively.
Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/
corrosion inhibitor concentrate in accordance with MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
i The coolant is checked at every maintenance interval at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Windscreen washer concentrate is highly
flammable. If it comes into contact with hot
engine components or the exhaust system it
could ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that no windscreen washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and
WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the
spraying nozzles could become blocked.
When handling washer fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 354).
At temperatures above freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
Adapt the mixing ratio to the outside temperature.
X
RDown to Ò10 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit to
2 parts water.
RDown to Ò20 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit to
1 part water.
RDown to Ò29 †: mix 2 parts MB WinterFit to
1 part water.
Z
Technical data
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
361
362
Vehicle data
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
Model
Vehicle data
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
Technical data
Rthe
heights specified may vary as a result
of:
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload.
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 354).
Ronly for certain countries: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
Dimensions and weights
:
Opening
height
CLA 180 CDI
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
1749 mm
AMG vehicles
1727 mm
All other models
1745 mm
Missing values were not available at the time
of going to print.
All models
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2032 mm
Vehicle width
excluding exterior
mirrors
1777 mm
Wheelbase
2699 mm
Maximum boot load
Model
100 kg
Vehicle length
AMG vehicles
4691 mm
All other models
4630 mm
Model
Vehicle height
CLA 180 CDI
CLA 250
CLA 250 4MATIC
1436 mm
AMG vehicles
1416 mm
All other models
1432 mm
Trailer tow hitch
Model
Maximum
roof load
CLA 180 CDI
CLA 180, automatic
transmission
CLA 200 CDI
CLA 250 4MATIC
All other models
363
CLA 180, CLA 250 4MATIC and
CLA 200 CDI: For trailer tow hitches fitted at
the factory, the overhang dimension including
protective covering is 2032 mm.
CLA 200, CLA 250 and CLA 220 CDI: For
trailer tow hitches fitted at the factory, the
overhang dimension including protective covering is 1121 mm.
100 kg
Trailer tow hitch
Mounting dimensions
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
changes to the engine cooling system may
be necessary, depending on the vehicle
type.
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis.
RCLA
RCLA
Technical data
Trailer towing is not permissible on the following models:
180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition
45 AMG 4MATIC
Example: anchorage points for the trailer tow hitch
: Anchorage points
; Overhang dimension
= Rear axle centre line
Z
364
Trailer tow hitch
Trailer loads
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 8%
from a standstill)
The CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition and CLA 45 AMG 4MATIC cannot be used to tow a trailer.
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
CLA 180
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 200
1500 kg
1500 kg
CLA 200 CDI
Automatic transmission
CLA 250
1500 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
Technical data
CLA 220 CDI
1500 kg
Permissible trailer load, braked (at a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12%
from a standstill)
The CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition and CLA 45 AMG 4MATIC cannot be used to tow a trailer.
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
CLA 180
1200 kg
CLA 200
1400 kg
Automatic transmission
1400 kg
CLA 200 CDI
Automatic transmission
CLA 250
1500 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
CLA 220 CDI
1500 kg
Permissible trailer load, unbraked
The CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition and CLA 45 AMG 4MATIC cannot be used to tow a trailer.
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Trailer tow hitch
Manual transmission
CLA 180
695 kg
CLA 200
695 kg
365
Automatic transmission
715 kg
CLA 200 CDI
Automatic transmission
CLA 250
740 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
CLA 220 CDI
750 kg
Maximum drawbar noseweight
! Use a drawbar noseweight as close as possible to the maximum permissible noseweight.
The drawbar noseweight is not included in the trailer load.
The CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition and CLA 45 AMG 4MATIC cannot be used to tow a trailer.
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
CLA 180
75 kg
CLA 200
75 kg
Automatic transmission
75 kg
CLA 200 CDI
Automatic transmission
CLA 250
75 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
CLA 220 CDI
75 kg
The actual noseweight may not be higher than the value which is given. The value can be found
on the trailer tow hitch or trailer identification plates. The lowest weight applies.
You can attach carrier systems, e.g. bicycle racks or load-bearing implements, on the ball
coupling. The maximum noseweight of 75 kg applies when using carrier systems on the ball
coupling.
Z
Technical data
Do not use a noseweight of less than 50kg, otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Note that the payload and the rear axle load are reduced by the actual payload.
366
Trailer tow hitch
Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer
The CLA 180 BlueEFFICIENCY Edition and CLA 45 AMG 4MATIC cannot be used to tow a trailer.
Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Manual transmission
CLA 180
980 kg
CLA 200
980 kg
Automatic transmission
985 kg
CLA 200 CDI
Automatic transmission
CLA 250
995 kg
CLA 250 4MATIC
Technical data
CLA 220 CDI
980 kg
367
368